1 /* Variable tracking routines for the GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 2002-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
7 under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
8 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
12 ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
13 or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
14 License for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* This file contains the variable tracking pass. It computes where
21 variables are located (which registers or where in memory) at each position
22 in instruction stream and emits notes describing the locations.
23 Debug information (DWARF2 location lists) is finally generated from
25 With this debug information, it is possible to show variables
26 even when debugging optimized code.
28 How does the variable tracking pass work?
30 First, it scans RTL code for uses, stores and clobbers (register/memory
31 references in instructions), for call insns and for stack adjustments
32 separately for each basic block and saves them to an array of micro
34 The micro operations of one instruction are ordered so that
35 pre-modifying stack adjustment < use < use with no var < call insn <
36 < clobber < set < post-modifying stack adjustment
38 Then, a forward dataflow analysis is performed to find out how locations
39 of variables change through code and to propagate the variable locations
40 along control flow graph.
41 The IN set for basic block BB is computed as a union of OUT sets of BB's
42 predecessors, the OUT set for BB is copied from the IN set for BB and
43 is changed according to micro operations in BB.
45 The IN and OUT sets for basic blocks consist of a current stack adjustment
46 (used for adjusting offset of variables addressed using stack pointer),
47 the table of structures describing the locations of parts of a variable
48 and for each physical register a linked list for each physical register.
49 The linked list is a list of variable parts stored in the register,
50 i.e. it is a list of triplets (reg, decl, offset) where decl is
51 REG_EXPR (reg) and offset is REG_OFFSET (reg). The linked list is used for
52 effective deleting appropriate variable parts when we set or clobber the
55 There may be more than one variable part in a register. The linked lists
56 should be pretty short so it is a good data structure here.
57 For example in the following code, register allocator may assign same
58 register to variables A and B, and both of them are stored in the same
71 Finally, the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION notes describing the variable locations
72 are emitted to appropriate positions in RTL code. Each such a note describes
73 the location of one variable at the point in instruction stream where the
74 note is. There is no need to emit a note for each variable before each
75 instruction, we only emit these notes where the location of variable changes
76 (this means that we also emit notes for changes between the OUT set of the
77 previous block and the IN set of the current block).
79 The notes consist of two parts:
80 1. the declaration (from REG_EXPR or MEM_EXPR)
81 2. the location of a variable - it is either a simple register/memory
82 reference (for simple variables, for example int),
83 or a parallel of register/memory references (for a large variables
84 which consist of several parts, for example long long).
90 #include "coretypes.h"
95 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
96 #include "basic-block.h"
98 #include "insn-config.h"
101 #include "alloc-pool.h"
106 #include "tree-pass.h"
107 #include "tree-flow.h"
111 #include "diagnostic.h"
112 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
113 #include "pointer-set.h"
118 /* var-tracking.c assumes that tree code with the same value as VALUE rtx code
119 has no chance to appear in REG_EXPR/MEM_EXPRs and isn't a decl.
120 Currently the value is the same as IDENTIFIER_NODE, which has such
121 a property. If this compile time assertion ever fails, make sure that
122 the new tree code that equals (int) VALUE has the same property. */
123 extern char check_value_val
[(int) VALUE
== (int) IDENTIFIER_NODE
? 1 : -1];
125 /* Type of micro operation. */
126 enum micro_operation_type
128 MO_USE
, /* Use location (REG or MEM). */
129 MO_USE_NO_VAR
,/* Use location which is not associated with a variable
130 or the variable is not trackable. */
131 MO_VAL_USE
, /* Use location which is associated with a value. */
132 MO_VAL_LOC
, /* Use location which appears in a debug insn. */
133 MO_VAL_SET
, /* Set location associated with a value. */
134 MO_SET
, /* Set location. */
135 MO_COPY
, /* Copy the same portion of a variable from one
136 location to another. */
137 MO_CLOBBER
, /* Clobber location. */
138 MO_CALL
, /* Call insn. */
139 MO_ADJUST
/* Adjust stack pointer. */
143 static const char * const ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
144 micro_operation_type_name
[] = {
157 /* Where shall the note be emitted? BEFORE or AFTER the instruction.
158 Notes emitted as AFTER_CALL are to take effect during the call,
159 rather than after the call. */
162 EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
163 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN
,
164 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
167 /* Structure holding information about micro operation. */
168 typedef struct micro_operation_def
170 /* Type of micro operation. */
171 enum micro_operation_type type
;
173 /* The instruction which the micro operation is in, for MO_USE,
174 MO_USE_NO_VAR, MO_CALL and MO_ADJUST, or the subsequent
175 instruction or note in the original flow (before any var-tracking
176 notes are inserted, to simplify emission of notes), for MO_SET
181 /* Location. For MO_SET and MO_COPY, this is the SET that
182 performs the assignment, if known, otherwise it is the target
183 of the assignment. For MO_VAL_USE and MO_VAL_SET, it is a
184 CONCAT of the VALUE and the LOC associated with it. For
185 MO_VAL_LOC, it is a CONCAT of the VALUE and the VAR_LOCATION
186 associated with it. */
189 /* Stack adjustment. */
190 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust
;
195 /* A declaration of a variable, or an RTL value being handled like a
197 typedef void *decl_or_value
;
199 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
200 emit_note_insn_var_location. */
201 typedef struct emit_note_data_def
203 /* The instruction which the note will be emitted before/after. */
206 /* Where the note will be emitted (before/after insn)? */
207 enum emit_note_where where
;
209 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
213 /* Description of location of a part of a variable. The content of a physical
214 register is described by a chain of these structures.
215 The chains are pretty short (usually 1 or 2 elements) and thus
216 chain is the best data structure. */
217 typedef struct attrs_def
219 /* Pointer to next member of the list. */
220 struct attrs_def
*next
;
222 /* The rtx of register. */
225 /* The declaration corresponding to LOC. */
228 /* Offset from start of DECL. */
229 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
232 /* Structure holding a refcounted hash table. If refcount > 1,
233 it must be first unshared before modified. */
234 typedef struct shared_hash_def
236 /* Reference count. */
239 /* Actual hash table. */
243 /* Structure holding the IN or OUT set for a basic block. */
244 typedef struct dataflow_set_def
246 /* Adjustment of stack offset. */
247 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust
;
249 /* Attributes for registers (lists of attrs). */
250 attrs regs
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
252 /* Variable locations. */
255 /* Vars that is being traversed. */
256 shared_hash traversed_vars
;
259 /* The structure (one for each basic block) containing the information
260 needed for variable tracking. */
261 typedef struct variable_tracking_info_def
263 /* The vector of micro operations. */
264 vec
<micro_operation
> mos
;
266 /* The IN and OUT set for dataflow analysis. */
270 /* The permanent-in dataflow set for this block. This is used to
271 hold values for which we had to compute entry values. ??? This
272 should probably be dynamically allocated, to avoid using more
273 memory in non-debug builds. */
276 /* Has the block been visited in DFS? */
279 /* Has the block been flooded in VTA? */
282 } *variable_tracking_info
;
284 /* Structure for chaining the locations. */
285 typedef struct location_chain_def
287 /* Next element in the chain. */
288 struct location_chain_def
*next
;
290 /* The location (REG, MEM or VALUE). */
293 /* The "value" stored in this location. */
297 enum var_init_status init
;
300 /* A vector of loc_exp_dep holds the active dependencies of a one-part
301 DV on VALUEs, i.e., the VALUEs expanded so as to form the current
302 location of DV. Each entry is also part of VALUE' s linked-list of
303 backlinks back to DV. */
304 typedef struct loc_exp_dep_s
306 /* The dependent DV. */
308 /* The dependency VALUE or DECL_DEBUG. */
310 /* The next entry in VALUE's backlinks list. */
311 struct loc_exp_dep_s
*next
;
312 /* A pointer to the pointer to this entry (head or prev's next) in
313 the doubly-linked list. */
314 struct loc_exp_dep_s
**pprev
;
318 /* This data structure holds information about the depth of a variable
320 typedef struct expand_depth_struct
322 /* This measures the complexity of the expanded expression. It
323 grows by one for each level of expansion that adds more than one
326 /* This counts the number of ENTRY_VALUE expressions in an
327 expansion. We want to minimize their use. */
331 /* This data structure is allocated for one-part variables at the time
332 of emitting notes. */
335 /* Doubly-linked list of dependent DVs. These are DVs whose cur_loc
336 computation used the expansion of this variable, and that ought
337 to be notified should this variable change. If the DV's cur_loc
338 expanded to NULL, all components of the loc list are regarded as
339 active, so that any changes in them give us a chance to get a
340 location. Otherwise, only components of the loc that expanded to
341 non-NULL are regarded as active dependencies. */
342 loc_exp_dep
*backlinks
;
343 /* This holds the LOC that was expanded into cur_loc. We need only
344 mark a one-part variable as changed if the FROM loc is removed,
345 or if it has no known location and a loc is added, or if it gets
346 a change notification from any of its active dependencies. */
348 /* The depth of the cur_loc expression. */
350 /* Dependencies actively used when expand FROM into cur_loc. */
351 vec
<loc_exp_dep
, va_heap
, vl_embed
> deps
;
354 /* Structure describing one part of variable. */
355 typedef struct variable_part_def
357 /* Chain of locations of the part. */
358 location_chain loc_chain
;
360 /* Location which was last emitted to location list. */
365 /* The offset in the variable, if !var->onepart. */
366 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
368 /* Pointer to auxiliary data, if var->onepart and emit_notes. */
369 struct onepart_aux
*onepaux
;
373 /* Maximum number of location parts. */
374 #define MAX_VAR_PARTS 16
376 /* Enumeration type used to discriminate various types of one-part
378 typedef enum onepart_enum
380 /* Not a one-part variable. */
382 /* A one-part DECL that is not a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
384 /* A DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
390 /* Structure describing where the variable is located. */
391 typedef struct variable_def
393 /* The declaration of the variable, or an RTL value being handled
394 like a declaration. */
397 /* Reference count. */
400 /* Number of variable parts. */
403 /* What type of DV this is, according to enum onepart_enum. */
404 ENUM_BITFIELD (onepart_enum
) onepart
: CHAR_BIT
;
406 /* True if this variable_def struct is currently in the
407 changed_variables hash table. */
408 bool in_changed_variables
;
410 /* The variable parts. */
411 variable_part var_part
[1];
413 typedef const struct variable_def
*const_variable
;
415 /* Pointer to the BB's information specific to variable tracking pass. */
416 #define VTI(BB) ((variable_tracking_info) (BB)->aux)
418 /* Macro to access MEM_OFFSET as an HOST_WIDE_INT. Evaluates MEM twice. */
419 #define INT_MEM_OFFSET(mem) (MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem) ? MEM_OFFSET (mem) : 0)
421 #if ENABLE_CHECKING && (GCC_VERSION >= 2007)
423 /* Access VAR's Ith part's offset, checking that it's not a one-part
425 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) __extension__ \
426 (*({ variable const __v = (var); \
427 gcc_checking_assert (!__v->onepart); \
428 &__v->var_part[(i)].aux.offset; }))
430 /* Access VAR's one-part auxiliary data, checking that it is a
431 one-part variable. */
432 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) __extension__ \
433 (*({ variable const __v = (var); \
434 gcc_checking_assert (__v->onepart); \
435 &__v->var_part[0].aux.onepaux; }))
438 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) ((var)->var_part[(i)].aux.offset)
439 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) ((var)->var_part[0].aux.onepaux)
442 /* These are accessor macros for the one-part auxiliary data. When
443 convenient for users, they're guarded by tests that the data was
445 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LST(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
446 ? VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
448 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
449 ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
451 #define VAR_LOC_FROM(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->from)
452 #define VAR_LOC_DEPTH(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth)
453 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
454 ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->deps \
457 /* Alloc pool for struct attrs_def. */
458 static alloc_pool attrs_pool
;
460 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with MAX_VAR_PARTS entries. */
461 static alloc_pool var_pool
;
463 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with a single var_part entry. */
464 static alloc_pool valvar_pool
;
466 /* Alloc pool for struct location_chain_def. */
467 static alloc_pool loc_chain_pool
;
469 /* Alloc pool for struct shared_hash_def. */
470 static alloc_pool shared_hash_pool
;
472 /* Alloc pool for struct loc_exp_dep_s for NOT_ONEPART variables. */
473 static alloc_pool loc_exp_dep_pool
;
475 /* Changed variables, notes will be emitted for them. */
476 static htab_t changed_variables
;
478 /* Shall notes be emitted? */
479 static bool emit_notes
;
481 /* Values whose dynamic location lists have gone empty, but whose
482 cselib location lists are still usable. Use this to hold the
483 current location, the backlinks, etc, during emit_notes. */
484 static htab_t dropped_values
;
486 /* Empty shared hashtable. */
487 static shared_hash empty_shared_hash
;
489 /* Scratch register bitmap used by cselib_expand_value_rtx. */
490 static bitmap scratch_regs
= NULL
;
492 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
493 typedef struct GTY(()) parm_reg
{
499 /* Vector of windowed parameter registers, if any. */
500 static vec
<parm_reg_t
, va_gc
> *windowed_parm_regs
= NULL
;
503 /* Variable used to tell whether cselib_process_insn called our hook. */
504 static bool cselib_hook_called
;
506 /* Local function prototypes. */
507 static void stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*,
509 static void insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*,
511 static bool vt_stack_adjustments (void);
512 static hashval_t
variable_htab_hash (const void *);
513 static int variable_htab_eq (const void *, const void *);
514 static void variable_htab_free (void *);
516 static void init_attrs_list_set (attrs
*);
517 static void attrs_list_clear (attrs
*);
518 static attrs
attrs_list_member (attrs
, decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
519 static void attrs_list_insert (attrs
*, decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
, rtx
);
520 static void attrs_list_copy (attrs
*, attrs
);
521 static void attrs_list_union (attrs
*, attrs
);
523 static void **unshare_variable (dataflow_set
*set
, void **slot
, variable var
,
524 enum var_init_status
);
525 static void vars_copy (htab_t
, htab_t
);
526 static tree
var_debug_decl (tree
);
527 static void var_reg_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
528 static void var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool,
529 enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
530 static void var_reg_delete (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool);
531 static void var_regno_delete (dataflow_set
*, int);
532 static void var_mem_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
533 static void var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool,
534 enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
535 static void var_mem_delete (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool);
537 static void dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set
*);
538 static void dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set
*);
539 static void dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set
*);
540 static int variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *, const void *);
541 static void dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set
*);
542 static location_chain
find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx
, variable
, htab_t
);
543 static bool canon_value_cmp (rtx
, rtx
);
544 static int loc_cmp (rtx
, rtx
);
545 static bool variable_part_different_p (variable_part
*, variable_part
*);
546 static bool onepart_variable_different_p (variable
, variable
);
547 static bool variable_different_p (variable
, variable
);
548 static bool dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set
*);
549 static void dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set
*);
551 static bool contains_symbol_ref (rtx
);
552 static bool track_expr_p (tree
, bool);
553 static bool same_variable_part_p (rtx
, tree
, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
554 static int add_uses (rtx
*, void *);
555 static void add_uses_1 (rtx
*, void *);
556 static void add_stores (rtx
, const_rtx
, void *);
557 static bool compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block
);
558 static bool vt_find_locations (void);
560 static void dump_attrs_list (attrs
);
561 static int dump_var_slot (void **, void *);
562 static void dump_var (variable
);
563 static void dump_vars (htab_t
);
564 static void dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set
*);
565 static void dump_dataflow_sets (void);
567 static void set_dv_changed (decl_or_value
, bool);
568 static void variable_was_changed (variable
, dataflow_set
*);
569 static void **set_slot_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, void **,
570 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
,
571 enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
572 static void set_variable_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
573 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
,
574 enum var_init_status
, rtx
, enum insert_option
);
575 static void **clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
576 void **, HOST_WIDE_INT
, rtx
);
577 static void clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
578 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
, rtx
);
579 static void **delete_slot_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, void **, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
580 static void delete_variable_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
581 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
582 static int emit_note_insn_var_location (void **, void *);
583 static void emit_notes_for_changes (rtx
, enum emit_note_where
, shared_hash
);
584 static int emit_notes_for_differences_1 (void **, void *);
585 static int emit_notes_for_differences_2 (void **, void *);
586 static void emit_notes_for_differences (rtx
, dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set
*);
587 static void emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block
, dataflow_set
*);
588 static void vt_emit_notes (void);
590 static bool vt_get_decl_and_offset (rtx
, tree
*, HOST_WIDE_INT
*);
591 static void vt_add_function_parameters (void);
592 static bool vt_initialize (void);
593 static void vt_finalize (void);
595 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
596 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer.
597 This function is similar to stack_adjust_offset. */
600 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx pattern
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*pre
,
603 rtx src
= SET_SRC (pattern
);
604 rtx dest
= SET_DEST (pattern
);
607 if (dest
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
609 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
610 code
= GET_CODE (src
);
611 if (! (code
== PLUS
|| code
== MINUS
)
612 || XEXP (src
, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
613 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src
, 1)))
617 *post
+= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
619 *post
-= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
621 else if (MEM_P (dest
))
623 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
624 src
= XEXP (dest
, 0);
625 code
= GET_CODE (src
);
631 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
633 rtx val
= XEXP (XEXP (src
, 1), 1);
634 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
635 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == PLUS
&&
638 if (code
== PRE_MODIFY
)
639 *pre
-= INTVAL (val
);
641 *post
-= INTVAL (val
);
647 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
649 *pre
+= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
655 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
657 *post
+= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
663 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
665 *pre
-= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
671 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
673 *post
-= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
684 /* Given an INSN, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
685 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer. */
688 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx insn
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*pre
,
696 pattern
= PATTERN (insn
);
697 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn
))
699 rtx expr
= find_reg_note (insn
, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR
, NULL_RTX
);
701 pattern
= XEXP (expr
, 0);
704 if (GET_CODE (pattern
) == SET
)
705 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (pattern
, pre
, post
);
706 else if (GET_CODE (pattern
) == PARALLEL
707 || GET_CODE (pattern
) == SEQUENCE
)
711 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
713 for ( i
= XVECLEN (pattern
, 0) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
714 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern
, 0, i
)) == SET
)
715 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (XVECEXP (pattern
, 0, i
), pre
, post
);
719 /* Compute stack adjustments for all blocks by traversing DFS tree.
720 Return true when the adjustments on all incoming edges are consistent.
721 Heavily borrowed from pre_and_rev_post_order_compute. */
724 vt_stack_adjustments (void)
726 edge_iterator
*stack
;
729 /* Initialize entry block. */
730 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR
)->visited
= true;
731 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR
)->in
.stack_adjust
= INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
;
732 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR
)->out
.stack_adjust
= INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
;
734 /* Allocate stack for back-tracking up CFG. */
735 stack
= XNEWVEC (edge_iterator
, n_basic_blocks
+ 1);
738 /* Push the first edge on to the stack. */
739 stack
[sp
++] = ei_start (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR
->succs
);
747 /* Look at the edge on the top of the stack. */
749 src
= ei_edge (ei
)->src
;
750 dest
= ei_edge (ei
)->dest
;
752 /* Check if the edge destination has been visited yet. */
753 if (!VTI (dest
)->visited
)
756 HOST_WIDE_INT pre
, post
, offset
;
757 VTI (dest
)->visited
= true;
758 VTI (dest
)->in
.stack_adjust
= offset
= VTI (src
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
760 if (dest
!= EXIT_BLOCK_PTR
)
761 for (insn
= BB_HEAD (dest
);
762 insn
!= NEXT_INSN (BB_END (dest
));
763 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
))
766 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn
, &pre
, &post
);
767 offset
+= pre
+ post
;
770 VTI (dest
)->out
.stack_adjust
= offset
;
772 if (EDGE_COUNT (dest
->succs
) > 0)
773 /* Since the DEST node has been visited for the first
774 time, check its successors. */
775 stack
[sp
++] = ei_start (dest
->succs
);
779 /* Check whether the adjustments on the edges are the same. */
780 if (VTI (dest
)->in
.stack_adjust
!= VTI (src
)->out
.stack_adjust
)
786 if (! ei_one_before_end_p (ei
))
787 /* Go to the next edge. */
788 ei_next (&stack
[sp
- 1]);
790 /* Return to previous level if there are no more edges. */
799 /* arg_pointer_rtx resp. frame_pointer_rtx if stack_pointer_rtx or
800 hard_frame_pointer_rtx is being mapped to it and offset for it. */
801 static rtx cfa_base_rtx
;
802 static HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_base_offset
;
804 /* Compute a CFA-based value for an ADJUSTMENT made to stack_pointer_rtx
805 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx. */
808 compute_cfa_pointer (HOST_WIDE_INT adjustment
)
810 return plus_constant (Pmode
, cfa_base_rtx
, adjustment
+ cfa_base_offset
);
813 /* Adjustment for hard_frame_pointer_rtx to cfa base reg,
814 or -1 if the replacement shouldn't be done. */
815 static HOST_WIDE_INT hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= -1;
817 /* Data for adjust_mems callback. */
819 struct adjust_mem_data
822 enum machine_mode mem_mode
;
823 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust
;
827 /* Helper for adjust_mems. Return 1 if *loc is unsuitable for
828 transformation of wider mode arithmetics to narrower mode,
829 -1 if it is suitable and subexpressions shouldn't be
830 traversed and 0 if it is suitable and subexpressions should
831 be traversed. Called through for_each_rtx. */
834 use_narrower_mode_test (rtx
*loc
, void *data
)
836 rtx subreg
= (rtx
) data
;
838 if (CONSTANT_P (*loc
))
840 switch (GET_CODE (*loc
))
843 if (cselib_lookup (*loc
, GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg
)), 0, VOIDmode
))
845 if (!validate_subreg (GET_MODE (subreg
), GET_MODE (*loc
),
846 *loc
, subreg_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (subreg
),
855 if (for_each_rtx (&XEXP (*loc
, 0), use_narrower_mode_test
, data
))
864 /* Transform X into narrower mode MODE from wider mode WMODE. */
867 use_narrower_mode (rtx x
, enum machine_mode mode
, enum machine_mode wmode
)
871 return lowpart_subreg (mode
, x
, wmode
);
872 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
875 return lowpart_subreg (mode
, x
, wmode
);
879 op0
= use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x
, 0), mode
, wmode
);
880 op1
= use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x
, 1), mode
, wmode
);
881 return simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (x
), mode
, op0
, op1
);
883 op0
= use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x
, 0), mode
, wmode
);
884 return simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFT
, mode
, op0
, XEXP (x
, 1));
890 /* Helper function for adjusting used MEMs. */
893 adjust_mems (rtx loc
, const_rtx old_rtx
, void *data
)
895 struct adjust_mem_data
*amd
= (struct adjust_mem_data
*) data
;
896 rtx mem
, addr
= loc
, tem
;
897 enum machine_mode mem_mode_save
;
899 switch (GET_CODE (loc
))
902 /* Don't do any sp or fp replacements outside of MEM addresses
904 if (amd
->mem_mode
== VOIDmode
&& amd
->store
)
906 if (loc
== stack_pointer_rtx
907 && !frame_pointer_needed
909 return compute_cfa_pointer (amd
->stack_adjust
);
910 else if (loc
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
911 && frame_pointer_needed
912 && hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
!= -1
914 return compute_cfa_pointer (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
);
915 gcc_checking_assert (loc
!= virtual_incoming_args_rtx
);
921 mem
= targetm
.delegitimize_address (mem
);
922 if (mem
!= loc
&& !MEM_P (mem
))
923 return simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
926 addr
= XEXP (mem
, 0);
927 mem_mode_save
= amd
->mem_mode
;
928 amd
->mem_mode
= GET_MODE (mem
);
929 store_save
= amd
->store
;
931 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
932 amd
->store
= store_save
;
933 amd
->mem_mode
= mem_mode_save
;
935 addr
= targetm
.delegitimize_address (addr
);
936 if (addr
!= XEXP (mem
, 0))
937 mem
= replace_equiv_address_nv (mem
, addr
);
939 mem
= avoid_constant_pool_reference (mem
);
943 addr
= gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (loc
), XEXP (loc
, 0),
944 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (loc
) == PRE_INC
945 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (amd
->mem_mode
)
946 : -GET_MODE_SIZE (amd
->mem_mode
)));
950 addr
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
951 gcc_assert (amd
->mem_mode
!= VOIDmode
&& amd
->mem_mode
!= BLKmode
);
952 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
953 tem
= gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (loc
), XEXP (loc
, 0),
954 GEN_INT ((GET_CODE (loc
) == PRE_INC
955 || GET_CODE (loc
) == POST_INC
)
956 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (amd
->mem_mode
)
957 : -GET_MODE_SIZE (amd
->mem_mode
)));
958 amd
->side_effects
= alloc_EXPR_LIST (0,
959 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
,
965 addr
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
968 addr
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
969 gcc_assert (amd
->mem_mode
!= VOIDmode
);
970 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
971 amd
->side_effects
= alloc_EXPR_LIST (0,
972 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
,
978 /* First try without delegitimization of whole MEMs and
979 avoid_constant_pool_reference, which is more likely to succeed. */
980 store_save
= amd
->store
;
982 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SUBREG_REG (loc
), old_rtx
, adjust_mems
,
984 amd
->store
= store_save
;
985 mem
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
986 if (mem
== SUBREG_REG (loc
))
991 tem
= simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc
), mem
,
992 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc
)),
996 tem
= simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc
), addr
,
997 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc
)),
1000 tem
= gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (loc
), addr
, SUBREG_BYTE (loc
));
1002 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
1003 && GET_CODE (tem
) == SUBREG
1004 && (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == PLUS
1005 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == MINUS
1006 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == MULT
1007 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == ASHIFT
)
1008 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (tem
)) == MODE_INT
1009 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
))) == MODE_INT
1010 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tem
))
1011 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)))
1012 && subreg_lowpart_p (tem
)
1013 && !for_each_rtx (&SUBREG_REG (tem
), use_narrower_mode_test
, tem
))
1014 return use_narrower_mode (SUBREG_REG (tem
), GET_MODE (tem
),
1015 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)));
1018 /* Don't do any replacements in second and following
1019 ASM_OPERANDS of inline-asm with multiple sets.
1020 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC, ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC
1021 and ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC need to be equal between
1022 all the ASM_OPERANDs in the insn and adjust_insn will
1024 if (ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (loc
) != 0)
1033 /* Helper function for replacement of uses. */
1036 adjust_mem_uses (rtx
*x
, void *data
)
1038 rtx new_x
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (*x
, NULL_RTX
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1040 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, x
, new_x
, true);
1043 /* Helper function for replacement of stores. */
1046 adjust_mem_stores (rtx loc
, const_rtx expr
, void *data
)
1050 rtx new_dest
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SET_DEST (expr
), NULL_RTX
,
1052 if (new_dest
!= SET_DEST (expr
))
1054 rtx xexpr
= CONST_CAST_RTX (expr
);
1055 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &SET_DEST (xexpr
), new_dest
, true);
1060 /* Simplify INSN. Remove all {PRE,POST}_{INC,DEC,MODIFY} rtxes,
1061 replace them with their value in the insn and add the side-effects
1062 as other sets to the insn. */
1065 adjust_insn (basic_block bb
, rtx insn
)
1067 struct adjust_mem_data amd
;
1070 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
1071 /* If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
1072 transformation OUTGOING_REGNO -> INCOMING_REGNO is done there. */
1073 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn
)
1074 && find_reg_note (insn
, REG_CFA_WINDOW_SAVE
, NULL_RTX
))
1076 unsigned int i
, nregs
= vec_safe_length (windowed_parm_regs
);
1077 rtx rtl
= gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
, rtvec_alloc (nregs
* 2));
1080 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (windowed_parm_regs
, i
, p
)
1082 XVECEXP (rtl
, 0, i
* 2)
1083 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
, p
->incoming
, p
->outgoing
);
1084 /* Do not clobber the attached DECL, but only the REG. */
1085 XVECEXP (rtl
, 0, i
* 2 + 1)
1086 = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (p
->outgoing
),
1087 gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (p
->outgoing
),
1088 REGNO (p
->outgoing
)));
1091 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &PATTERN (insn
), rtl
, true);
1096 amd
.mem_mode
= VOIDmode
;
1097 amd
.stack_adjust
= -VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
1098 amd
.side_effects
= NULL_RTX
;
1101 note_stores (PATTERN (insn
), adjust_mem_stores
, &amd
);
1104 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == PARALLEL
1105 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn
)) > 0
1106 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0, 0)) == SET
)
1111 /* inline-asm with multiple sets is tiny bit more complicated,
1112 because the 3 vectors in ASM_OPERANDS need to be shared between
1113 all ASM_OPERANDS in the instruction. adjust_mems will
1114 not touch ASM_OPERANDS other than the first one, asm_noperands
1115 test above needs to be called before that (otherwise it would fail)
1116 and afterwards this code fixes it up. */
1117 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn
), adjust_mem_uses
, &amd
);
1118 body
= PATTERN (insn
);
1119 set0
= XVECEXP (body
, 0, 0);
1120 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (set0
) == SET
1121 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set0
)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1122 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set0
)) == 0);
1123 for (i
= 1; i
< XVECLEN (body
, 0); i
++)
1124 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body
, 0, i
)) != SET
)
1128 set
= XVECEXP (body
, 0, i
);
1129 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1130 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set
))
1132 if (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set
))
1133 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
))
1134 || ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set
))
1135 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
))
1136 || ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set
))
1137 != ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
)))
1139 rtx newsrc
= shallow_copy_rtx (SET_SRC (set
));
1140 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (newsrc
)
1141 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
));
1142 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (newsrc
)
1143 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
));
1144 ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (newsrc
)
1145 = ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
));
1146 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &SET_SRC (set
), newsrc
, true);
1151 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn
), adjust_mem_uses
, &amd
);
1153 /* For read-only MEMs containing some constant, prefer those
1155 set
= single_set (insn
);
1156 if (set
&& MEM_P (SET_SRC (set
)) && MEM_READONLY_P (SET_SRC (set
)))
1158 rtx note
= find_reg_equal_equiv_note (insn
);
1160 if (note
&& CONSTANT_P (XEXP (note
, 0)))
1161 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &SET_SRC (set
), XEXP (note
, 0), true);
1164 if (amd
.side_effects
)
1166 rtx
*pat
, new_pat
, s
;
1169 pat
= &PATTERN (insn
);
1170 if (GET_CODE (*pat
) == COND_EXEC
)
1171 pat
= &COND_EXEC_CODE (*pat
);
1172 if (GET_CODE (*pat
) == PARALLEL
)
1173 oldn
= XVECLEN (*pat
, 0);
1176 for (s
= amd
.side_effects
, newn
= 0; s
; newn
++)
1178 new_pat
= gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
, rtvec_alloc (oldn
+ newn
));
1179 if (GET_CODE (*pat
) == PARALLEL
)
1180 for (i
= 0; i
< oldn
; i
++)
1181 XVECEXP (new_pat
, 0, i
) = XVECEXP (*pat
, 0, i
);
1183 XVECEXP (new_pat
, 0, 0) = *pat
;
1184 for (s
= amd
.side_effects
, i
= oldn
; i
< oldn
+ newn
; i
++, s
= XEXP (s
, 1))
1185 XVECEXP (new_pat
, 0, i
) = XEXP (s
, 0);
1186 free_EXPR_LIST_list (&amd
.side_effects
);
1187 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, pat
, new_pat
, true);
1191 /* Return true if a decl_or_value DV is a DECL or NULL. */
1193 dv_is_decl_p (decl_or_value dv
)
1195 return !dv
|| (int) TREE_CODE ((tree
) dv
) != (int) VALUE
;
1198 /* Return true if a decl_or_value is a VALUE rtl. */
1200 dv_is_value_p (decl_or_value dv
)
1202 return dv
&& !dv_is_decl_p (dv
);
1205 /* Return the decl in the decl_or_value. */
1207 dv_as_decl (decl_or_value dv
)
1209 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv
));
1213 /* Return the value in the decl_or_value. */
1215 dv_as_value (decl_or_value dv
)
1217 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv
));
1221 /* Return the DEBUG_EXPR of a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL or the VALUE in DV. */
1223 dv_as_rtx (decl_or_value dv
)
1227 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
1228 return dv_as_value (dv
);
1230 decl
= dv_as_decl (dv
);
1232 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (decl
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
);
1233 return DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (decl
);
1236 /* Return the opaque pointer in the decl_or_value. */
1237 static inline void *
1238 dv_as_opaque (decl_or_value dv
)
1243 /* Return nonzero if a decl_or_value must not have more than one
1244 variable part. The returned value discriminates among various
1245 kinds of one-part DVs ccording to enum onepart_enum. */
1246 static inline onepart_enum_t
1247 dv_onepart_p (decl_or_value dv
)
1251 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
1254 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
1255 return ONEPART_VALUE
;
1257 decl
= dv_as_decl (dv
);
1259 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
)
1260 return ONEPART_DEXPR
;
1262 if (target_for_debug_bind (decl
) != NULL_TREE
)
1263 return ONEPART_VDECL
;
1268 /* Return the variable pool to be used for a dv of type ONEPART. */
1269 static inline alloc_pool
1270 onepart_pool (onepart_enum_t onepart
)
1272 return onepart
? valvar_pool
: var_pool
;
1275 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a decl. */
1276 static inline decl_or_value
1277 dv_from_decl (tree decl
)
1281 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv
));
1285 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a value. */
1286 static inline decl_or_value
1287 dv_from_value (rtx value
)
1291 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv
));
1295 /* Return a value or the decl of a debug_expr as a decl_or_value. */
1296 static inline decl_or_value
1301 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
1304 dv
= dv_from_decl (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
));
1305 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
)) == x
);
1309 dv
= dv_from_value (x
);
1319 extern void debug_dv (decl_or_value dv
);
1322 debug_dv (decl_or_value dv
)
1324 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
1325 debug_rtx (dv_as_value (dv
));
1327 debug_generic_stmt (dv_as_decl (dv
));
1330 typedef unsigned int dvuid
;
1332 /* Return the uid of DV. */
1335 dv_uid (decl_or_value dv
)
1337 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
1338 return CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (dv
))->uid
;
1340 return DECL_UID (dv_as_decl (dv
));
1343 /* Compute the hash from the uid. */
1345 static inline hashval_t
1346 dv_uid2hash (dvuid uid
)
1351 /* The hash function for a mask table in a shared_htab chain. */
1353 static inline hashval_t
1354 dv_htab_hash (decl_or_value dv
)
1356 return dv_uid2hash (dv_uid (dv
));
1359 /* The hash function for variable_htab, computes the hash value
1360 from the declaration of variable X. */
1363 variable_htab_hash (const void *x
)
1365 const_variable
const v
= (const_variable
) x
;
1367 return dv_htab_hash (v
->dv
);
1370 /* Compare the declaration of variable X with declaration Y. */
1373 variable_htab_eq (const void *x
, const void *y
)
1375 const_variable
const v
= (const_variable
) x
;
1376 decl_or_value dv
= CONST_CAST2 (decl_or_value
, const void *, y
);
1378 return (dv_as_opaque (v
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
));
1381 static void loc_exp_dep_clear (variable var
);
1383 /* Free the element of VARIABLE_HTAB (its type is struct variable_def). */
1386 variable_htab_free (void *elem
)
1389 variable var
= (variable
) elem
;
1390 location_chain node
, next
;
1392 gcc_checking_assert (var
->refcount
> 0);
1395 if (var
->refcount
> 0)
1398 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
1400 for (node
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= next
)
1403 pool_free (loc_chain_pool
, node
);
1405 var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
= NULL
;
1407 if (var
->onepart
&& VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
1409 loc_exp_dep_clear (var
);
1410 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
))
1411 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
)->pprev
= NULL
;
1412 XDELETE (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
));
1413 /* These may be reused across functions, so reset
1415 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
1416 set_dv_changed (var
->dv
, true);
1418 pool_free (onepart_pool (var
->onepart
), var
);
1421 /* Initialize the set (array) SET of attrs to empty lists. */
1424 init_attrs_list_set (attrs
*set
)
1428 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
1432 /* Make the list *LISTP empty. */
1435 attrs_list_clear (attrs
*listp
)
1439 for (list
= *listp
; list
; list
= next
)
1442 pool_free (attrs_pool
, list
);
1447 /* Return true if the pair of DECL and OFFSET is the member of the LIST. */
1450 attrs_list_member (attrs list
, decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
1452 for (; list
; list
= list
->next
)
1453 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
) && list
->offset
== offset
)
1458 /* Insert the triplet DECL, OFFSET, LOC to the list *LISTP. */
1461 attrs_list_insert (attrs
*listp
, decl_or_value dv
,
1462 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx loc
)
1466 list
= (attrs
) pool_alloc (attrs_pool
);
1469 list
->offset
= offset
;
1470 list
->next
= *listp
;
1474 /* Copy all nodes from SRC and create a list *DSTP of the copies. */
1477 attrs_list_copy (attrs
*dstp
, attrs src
)
1481 attrs_list_clear (dstp
);
1482 for (; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1484 n
= (attrs
) pool_alloc (attrs_pool
);
1487 n
->offset
= src
->offset
;
1493 /* Add all nodes from SRC which are not in *DSTP to *DSTP. */
1496 attrs_list_union (attrs
*dstp
, attrs src
)
1498 for (; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1500 if (!attrs_list_member (*dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
))
1501 attrs_list_insert (dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
, src
->loc
);
1505 /* Combine nodes that are not onepart nodes from SRC and SRC2 into
1509 attrs_list_mpdv_union (attrs
*dstp
, attrs src
, attrs src2
)
1511 gcc_assert (!*dstp
);
1512 for (; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1514 if (!dv_onepart_p (src
->dv
))
1515 attrs_list_insert (dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
, src
->loc
);
1517 for (src
= src2
; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1519 if (!dv_onepart_p (src
->dv
)
1520 && !attrs_list_member (*dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
))
1521 attrs_list_insert (dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
, src
->loc
);
1525 /* Shared hashtable support. */
1527 /* Return true if VARS is shared. */
1530 shared_hash_shared (shared_hash vars
)
1532 return vars
->refcount
> 1;
1535 /* Return the hash table for VARS. */
1537 static inline htab_t
1538 shared_hash_htab (shared_hash vars
)
1543 /* Return true if VAR is shared, or maybe because VARS is shared. */
1546 shared_var_p (variable var
, shared_hash vars
)
1548 /* Don't count an entry in the changed_variables table as a duplicate. */
1549 return ((var
->refcount
> 1 + (int) var
->in_changed_variables
)
1550 || shared_hash_shared (vars
));
1553 /* Copy variables into a new hash table. */
1556 shared_hash_unshare (shared_hash vars
)
1558 shared_hash new_vars
= (shared_hash
) pool_alloc (shared_hash_pool
);
1559 gcc_assert (vars
->refcount
> 1);
1560 new_vars
->refcount
= 1;
1562 = htab_create (htab_elements (vars
->htab
) + 3, variable_htab_hash
,
1563 variable_htab_eq
, variable_htab_free
);
1564 vars_copy (new_vars
->htab
, vars
->htab
);
1569 /* Increment reference counter on VARS and return it. */
1571 static inline shared_hash
1572 shared_hash_copy (shared_hash vars
)
1578 /* Decrement reference counter and destroy hash table if not shared
1582 shared_hash_destroy (shared_hash vars
)
1584 gcc_checking_assert (vars
->refcount
> 0);
1585 if (--vars
->refcount
== 0)
1587 htab_delete (vars
->htab
);
1588 pool_free (shared_hash_pool
, vars
);
1592 /* Unshare *PVARS if shared and return slot for DV. If INS is
1593 INSERT, insert it if not already present. */
1595 static inline void **
1596 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (shared_hash
*pvars
, decl_or_value dv
,
1597 hashval_t dvhash
, enum insert_option ins
)
1599 if (shared_hash_shared (*pvars
))
1600 *pvars
= shared_hash_unshare (*pvars
);
1601 return htab_find_slot_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (*pvars
), dv
, dvhash
, ins
);
1604 static inline void **
1605 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (shared_hash
*pvars
, decl_or_value dv
,
1606 enum insert_option ins
)
1608 return shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (pvars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), ins
);
1611 /* Return slot for DV, if it is already present in the hash table.
1612 If it is not present, insert it only VARS is not shared, otherwise
1615 static inline void **
1616 shared_hash_find_slot_1 (shared_hash vars
, decl_or_value dv
, hashval_t dvhash
)
1618 return htab_find_slot_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (vars
), dv
, dvhash
,
1619 shared_hash_shared (vars
)
1620 ? NO_INSERT
: INSERT
);
1623 static inline void **
1624 shared_hash_find_slot (shared_hash vars
, decl_or_value dv
)
1626 return shared_hash_find_slot_1 (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
1629 /* Return slot for DV only if it is already present in the hash table. */
1631 static inline void **
1632 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (shared_hash vars
, decl_or_value dv
,
1635 return htab_find_slot_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (vars
), dv
, dvhash
,
1639 static inline void **
1640 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (shared_hash vars
, decl_or_value dv
)
1642 return shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
1645 /* Return variable for DV or NULL if not already present in the hash
1648 static inline variable
1649 shared_hash_find_1 (shared_hash vars
, decl_or_value dv
, hashval_t dvhash
)
1651 return (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (vars
), dv
, dvhash
);
1654 static inline variable
1655 shared_hash_find (shared_hash vars
, decl_or_value dv
)
1657 return shared_hash_find_1 (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
1660 /* Return true if TVAL is better than CVAL as a canonival value. We
1661 choose lowest-numbered VALUEs, using the RTX address as a
1662 tie-breaker. The idea is to arrange them into a star topology,
1663 such that all of them are at most one step away from the canonical
1664 value, and the canonical value has backlinks to all of them, in
1665 addition to all the actual locations. We don't enforce this
1666 topology throughout the entire dataflow analysis, though.
1670 canon_value_cmp (rtx tval
, rtx cval
)
1673 || CSELIB_VAL_PTR (tval
)->uid
< CSELIB_VAL_PTR (cval
)->uid
;
1676 static bool dst_can_be_shared
;
1678 /* Return a copy of a variable VAR and insert it to dataflow set SET. */
1681 unshare_variable (dataflow_set
*set
, void **slot
, variable var
,
1682 enum var_init_status initialized
)
1687 new_var
= (variable
) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (var
->onepart
));
1688 new_var
->dv
= var
->dv
;
1689 new_var
->refcount
= 1;
1691 new_var
->n_var_parts
= var
->n_var_parts
;
1692 new_var
->onepart
= var
->onepart
;
1693 new_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
1695 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
1696 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
1698 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
1700 location_chain node
;
1701 location_chain
*nextp
;
1703 if (i
== 0 && var
->onepart
)
1705 /* One-part auxiliary data is only used while emitting
1706 notes, so propagate it to the new variable in the active
1707 dataflow set. If we're not emitting notes, this will be
1709 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) || emit_notes
);
1710 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
1711 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
1714 VAR_PART_OFFSET (new_var
, i
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
);
1715 nextp
= &new_var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
;
1716 for (node
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
1718 location_chain new_lc
;
1720 new_lc
= (location_chain
) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool
);
1721 new_lc
->next
= NULL
;
1722 if (node
->init
> initialized
)
1723 new_lc
->init
= node
->init
;
1725 new_lc
->init
= initialized
;
1726 if (node
->set_src
&& !(MEM_P (node
->set_src
)))
1727 new_lc
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
1729 new_lc
->set_src
= NULL
;
1730 new_lc
->loc
= node
->loc
;
1733 nextp
= &new_lc
->next
;
1736 new_var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
;
1739 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
1740 if (shared_hash_shared (set
->vars
))
1741 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, var
->dv
, NO_INSERT
);
1742 else if (set
->traversed_vars
&& set
->vars
!= set
->traversed_vars
)
1743 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, var
->dv
);
1745 if (var
->in_changed_variables
)
1748 = htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables
, var
->dv
,
1749 dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
), NO_INSERT
);
1750 gcc_assert (*cslot
== (void *) var
);
1751 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
1752 variable_htab_free (var
);
1754 new_var
->in_changed_variables
= true;
1759 /* Copy all variables from hash table SRC to hash table DST. */
1762 vars_copy (htab_t dst
, htab_t src
)
1767 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (src
, var
, variable
, hi
)
1771 dstp
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (dst
, var
->dv
,
1772 dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
),
1778 /* Map a decl to its main debug decl. */
1781 var_debug_decl (tree decl
)
1783 if (decl
&& DECL_P (decl
)
1784 && DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl
))
1786 tree debugdecl
= DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl
);
1787 if (debugdecl
&& DECL_P (debugdecl
))
1794 /* Set the register LOC to contain DV, OFFSET. */
1797 var_reg_decl_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
1798 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
,
1799 enum insert_option iopt
)
1802 bool decl_p
= dv_is_decl_p (dv
);
1805 dv
= dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv
)));
1807 for (node
= set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)]; node
; node
= node
->next
)
1808 if (dv_as_opaque (node
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
)
1809 && node
->offset
== offset
)
1812 attrs_list_insert (&set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)], dv
, offset
, loc
);
1813 set_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv
, offset
, initialized
, set_src
, iopt
);
1816 /* Set the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). */
1819 var_reg_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
1822 tree decl
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
1823 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= REG_OFFSET (loc
);
1825 var_reg_decl_set (set
, loc
, initialized
,
1826 dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
, INSERT
);
1829 static enum var_init_status
1830 get_init_value (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, decl_or_value dv
)
1834 enum var_init_status ret_val
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
;
1836 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
1837 return VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
1839 var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
);
1842 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
&& ret_val
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
; i
++)
1844 location_chain nextp
;
1845 for (nextp
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; nextp
; nextp
= nextp
->next
)
1846 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp
->loc
, loc
))
1848 ret_val
= nextp
->init
;
1857 /* Delete current content of register LOC in dataflow set SET and set
1858 the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). If
1859 MODIFY is true, any other live copies of the same variable part are
1860 also deleted from the dataflow set, otherwise the variable part is
1861 assumed to be copied from another location holding the same
1865 var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool modify
,
1866 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
)
1868 tree decl
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
1869 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= REG_OFFSET (loc
);
1873 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
1875 if (initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
1876 initialized
= get_init_value (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
));
1878 nextp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)];
1879 for (node
= *nextp
; node
; node
= next
)
1882 if (dv_as_opaque (node
->dv
) != decl
|| node
->offset
!= offset
)
1884 delete_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
);
1885 pool_free (attrs_pool
, node
);
1891 nextp
= &node
->next
;
1895 clobber_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
);
1896 var_reg_set (set
, loc
, initialized
, set_src
);
1899 /* Delete the association of register LOC in dataflow set SET with any
1900 variables that aren't onepart. If CLOBBER is true, also delete any
1901 other live copies of the same variable part, and delete the
1902 association with onepart dvs too. */
1905 var_reg_delete (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool clobber
)
1907 attrs
*nextp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)];
1912 tree decl
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
1913 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= REG_OFFSET (loc
);
1915 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
1917 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, NULL
);
1920 for (node
= *nextp
; node
; node
= next
)
1923 if (clobber
|| !dv_onepart_p (node
->dv
))
1925 delete_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
);
1926 pool_free (attrs_pool
, node
);
1930 nextp
= &node
->next
;
1934 /* Delete content of register with number REGNO in dataflow set SET. */
1937 var_regno_delete (dataflow_set
*set
, int regno
)
1939 attrs
*reg
= &set
->regs
[regno
];
1942 for (node
= *reg
; node
; node
= next
)
1945 delete_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
);
1946 pool_free (attrs_pool
, node
);
1951 /* Return true if I is the negated value of a power of two. */
1953 negative_power_of_two_p (HOST_WIDE_INT i
)
1955 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT x
= -(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
)i
;
1956 return x
== (x
& -x
);
1959 /* Strip constant offsets and alignments off of LOC. Return the base
1963 vt_get_canonicalize_base (rtx loc
)
1965 while ((GET_CODE (loc
) == PLUS
1966 || GET_CODE (loc
) == AND
)
1967 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc
, 1)) == CONST_INT
1968 && (GET_CODE (loc
) != AND
1969 || negative_power_of_two_p (INTVAL (XEXP (loc
, 1)))))
1970 loc
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
1975 /* This caches canonicalized addresses for VALUEs, computed using
1976 information in the global cselib table. */
1977 static struct pointer_map_t
*global_get_addr_cache
;
1979 /* This caches canonicalized addresses for VALUEs, computed using
1980 information from the global cache and information pertaining to a
1981 basic block being analyzed. */
1982 static struct pointer_map_t
*local_get_addr_cache
;
1984 static rtx
vt_canonicalize_addr (dataflow_set
*, rtx
);
1986 /* Return the canonical address for LOC, that must be a VALUE, using a
1987 cached global equivalence or computing it and storing it in the
1991 get_addr_from_global_cache (rtx
const loc
)
1996 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
);
1998 slot
= pointer_map_insert (global_get_addr_cache
, loc
);
2002 x
= canon_rtx (get_addr (loc
));
2004 /* Tentative, avoiding infinite recursion. */
2009 rtx nx
= vt_canonicalize_addr (NULL
, x
);
2012 /* The table may have moved during recursion, recompute
2014 slot
= pointer_map_contains (global_get_addr_cache
, loc
);
2022 /* Return the canonical address for LOC, that must be a VALUE, using a
2023 cached local equivalence or computing it and storing it in the
2027 get_addr_from_local_cache (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx
const loc
)
2035 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
);
2037 slot
= pointer_map_insert (local_get_addr_cache
, loc
);
2041 x
= get_addr_from_global_cache (loc
);
2043 /* Tentative, avoiding infinite recursion. */
2046 /* Recurse to cache local expansion of X, or if we need to search
2047 for a VALUE in the expansion. */
2050 rtx nx
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, x
);
2053 slot
= pointer_map_contains (local_get_addr_cache
, loc
);
2059 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
2060 var
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
),
2061 dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
2065 /* Look for an improved equivalent expression. */
2066 for (l
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
2068 rtx base
= vt_get_canonicalize_base (l
->loc
);
2069 if (GET_CODE (base
) == VALUE
2070 && canon_value_cmp (base
, loc
))
2072 rtx nx
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, l
->loc
);
2075 slot
= pointer_map_contains (local_get_addr_cache
, loc
);
2085 /* Canonicalize LOC using equivalences from SET in addition to those
2086 in the cselib static table. It expects a VALUE-based expression,
2087 and it will only substitute VALUEs with other VALUEs or
2088 function-global equivalences, so that, if two addresses have base
2089 VALUEs that are locally or globally related in ways that
2090 memrefs_conflict_p cares about, they will both canonicalize to
2091 expressions that have the same base VALUE.
2093 The use of VALUEs as canonical base addresses enables the canonical
2094 RTXs to remain unchanged globally, if they resolve to a constant,
2095 or throughout a basic block otherwise, so that they can be cached
2096 and the cache needs not be invalidated when REGs, MEMs or such
2100 vt_canonicalize_addr (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx oloc
)
2102 HOST_WIDE_INT ofst
= 0;
2103 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (oloc
);
2110 while (GET_CODE (loc
) == PLUS
2111 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
2113 ofst
+= INTVAL (XEXP (loc
, 1));
2114 loc
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
2117 /* Alignment operations can't normally be combined, so just
2118 canonicalize the base and we're done. We'll normally have
2119 only one stack alignment anyway. */
2120 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == AND
2121 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc
, 1)) == CONST_INT
2122 && negative_power_of_two_p (INTVAL (XEXP (loc
, 1))))
2124 x
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, XEXP (loc
, 0));
2125 if (x
!= XEXP (loc
, 0))
2126 loc
= gen_rtx_AND (mode
, x
, XEXP (loc
, 1));
2130 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
)
2133 loc
= get_addr_from_local_cache (set
, loc
);
2135 loc
= get_addr_from_global_cache (loc
);
2137 /* Consolidate plus_constants. */
2138 while (ofst
&& GET_CODE (loc
) == PLUS
2139 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
2141 ofst
+= INTVAL (XEXP (loc
, 1));
2142 loc
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
2149 x
= canon_rtx (loc
);
2156 /* Add OFST back in. */
2159 /* Don't build new RTL if we can help it. */
2160 if (GET_CODE (oloc
) == PLUS
2161 && XEXP (oloc
, 0) == loc
2162 && INTVAL (XEXP (oloc
, 1)) == ofst
)
2165 loc
= plus_constant (mode
, loc
, ofst
);
2171 /* Return true iff there's a true dependence between MLOC and LOC.
2172 MADDR must be a canonicalized version of MLOC's address. */
2175 vt_canon_true_dep (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx mloc
, rtx maddr
, rtx loc
)
2177 if (GET_CODE (loc
) != MEM
)
2180 rtx addr
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, XEXP (loc
, 0));
2181 if (!canon_true_dependence (mloc
, GET_MODE (mloc
), maddr
, loc
, addr
))
2187 /* Hold parameters for the hashtab traversal function
2188 drop_overlapping_mem_locs, see below. */
2190 struct overlapping_mems
2196 /* Remove all MEMs that overlap with COMS->LOC from the location list
2197 of a hash table entry for a value. COMS->ADDR must be a
2198 canonicalized form of COMS->LOC's address, and COMS->LOC must be
2199 canonicalized itself. */
2202 drop_overlapping_mem_locs (void **slot
, void *data
)
2204 struct overlapping_mems
*coms
= (struct overlapping_mems
*)data
;
2205 dataflow_set
*set
= coms
->set
;
2206 rtx mloc
= coms
->loc
, addr
= coms
->addr
;
2207 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
2209 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
2211 location_chain loc
, *locp
;
2212 bool changed
= false;
2215 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2217 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
2219 for (loc
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
2220 if (vt_canon_true_dep (set
, mloc
, addr
, loc
->loc
))
2226 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
2227 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
2228 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2231 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
2232 cur_loc
= VAR_LOC_FROM (var
);
2234 cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
2236 for (locp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, loc
= *locp
;
2239 if (!vt_canon_true_dep (set
, mloc
, addr
, loc
->loc
))
2246 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
2247 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
2248 of changed variables. */
2249 if (cur_loc
== loc
->loc
)
2252 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
2253 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
2254 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
2256 pool_free (loc_chain_pool
, loc
);
2259 if (!var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
)
2265 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
2271 /* Remove from SET all VALUE bindings to MEMs that overlap with LOC. */
2274 clobber_overlapping_mems (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
)
2276 struct overlapping_mems coms
;
2278 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc
) == MEM
);
2281 coms
.loc
= canon_rtx (loc
);
2282 coms
.addr
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, XEXP (loc
, 0));
2284 set
->traversed_vars
= set
->vars
;
2285 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
),
2286 drop_overlapping_mem_locs
, &coms
);
2287 set
->traversed_vars
= NULL
;
2290 /* Set the location of DV, OFFSET as the MEM LOC. */
2293 var_mem_decl_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
2294 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
,
2295 enum insert_option iopt
)
2297 if (dv_is_decl_p (dv
))
2298 dv
= dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv
)));
2300 set_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv
, offset
, initialized
, set_src
, iopt
);
2303 /* Set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in dataflow set
2305 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2308 var_mem_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
2311 tree decl
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
2312 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
);
2314 var_mem_decl_set (set
, loc
, initialized
,
2315 dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
, INSERT
);
2318 /* Delete and set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in
2319 dataflow set SET to LOC. If MODIFY is true, any other live copies
2320 of the same variable part are also deleted from the dataflow set,
2321 otherwise the variable part is assumed to be copied from another
2322 location holding the same part.
2323 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2326 var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool modify
,
2327 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
)
2329 tree decl
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
2330 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
);
2332 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, loc
);
2333 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
2335 if (initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
2336 initialized
= get_init_value (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
));
2339 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
);
2340 var_mem_set (set
, loc
, initialized
, set_src
);
2343 /* Delete the location part LOC from dataflow set SET. If CLOBBER is
2344 true, also delete any other live copies of the same variable part.
2345 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2348 var_mem_delete (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool clobber
)
2350 tree decl
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
2351 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
);
2353 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, loc
);
2354 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
2356 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, NULL
);
2357 delete_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
);
2360 /* Return true if LOC should not be expanded for location expressions,
2364 unsuitable_loc (rtx loc
)
2366 switch (GET_CODE (loc
))
2380 /* Bind VAL to LOC in SET. If MODIFIED, detach LOC from any values
2384 val_bind (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx val
, rtx loc
, bool modified
)
2389 var_regno_delete (set
, REGNO (loc
));
2390 var_reg_decl_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
2391 dv_from_value (val
), 0, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2393 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
2395 struct elt_loc_list
*l
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (val
)->locs
;
2398 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, loc
);
2400 if (l
&& GET_CODE (l
->loc
) == VALUE
)
2401 l
= canonical_cselib_val (CSELIB_VAL_PTR (l
->loc
))->locs
;
2403 /* If this MEM is a global constant, we don't need it in the
2404 dynamic tables. ??? We should test this before emitting the
2405 micro-op in the first place. */
2407 if (GET_CODE (l
->loc
) == MEM
&& XEXP (l
->loc
, 0) == XEXP (loc
, 0))
2413 var_mem_decl_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
2414 dv_from_value (val
), 0, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2418 /* Other kinds of equivalences are necessarily static, at least
2419 so long as we do not perform substitutions while merging
2422 set_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv_from_value (val
), 0,
2423 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2427 /* Bind a value to a location it was just stored in. If MODIFIED
2428 holds, assume the location was modified, detaching it from any
2429 values bound to it. */
2432 val_store (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx val
, rtx loc
, rtx insn
, bool modified
)
2434 cselib_val
*v
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (val
);
2436 gcc_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (v
));
2440 fprintf (dump_file
, "%i: ", insn
? INSN_UID (insn
) : 0);
2441 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, loc
, 0);
2442 fprintf (dump_file
, " evaluates to ");
2443 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, val
, 0);
2446 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
2447 for (l
= v
->locs
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
2449 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n%i: ", INSN_UID (l
->setting_insn
));
2450 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, l
->loc
, 0);
2453 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
2456 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc
));
2458 val_bind (set
, val
, loc
, modified
);
2461 /* Clear (canonical address) slots that reference X. */
2464 local_get_addr_clear_given_value (const void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
2465 void **slot
, void *x
)
2467 if (vt_get_canonicalize_base ((rtx
)*slot
) == x
)
2472 /* Reset this node, detaching all its equivalences. Return the slot
2473 in the variable hash table that holds dv, if there is one. */
2476 val_reset (dataflow_set
*set
, decl_or_value dv
)
2478 variable var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
) ;
2479 location_chain node
;
2482 if (!var
|| !var
->n_var_parts
)
2485 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2487 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
2489 rtx x
= dv_as_value (dv
);
2492 /* Relationships in the global cache don't change, so reset the
2493 local cache entry only. */
2494 slot
= pointer_map_contains (local_get_addr_cache
, x
);
2497 /* If the value resolved back to itself, odds are that other
2498 values may have cached it too. These entries now refer
2499 to the old X, so detach them too. Entries that used the
2500 old X but resolved to something else remain ok as long as
2501 that something else isn't also reset. */
2503 pointer_map_traverse (local_get_addr_cache
,
2504 local_get_addr_clear_given_value
, x
);
2510 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2511 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
2512 && canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, cval
))
2515 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2516 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
&& cval
!= node
->loc
)
2518 /* Redirect the equivalence link to the new canonical
2519 value, or simply remove it if it would point at
2522 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, dv_from_value (node
->loc
),
2523 0, node
->init
, node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2524 delete_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (dv
),
2525 dv_from_value (node
->loc
), 0);
2530 decl_or_value cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
2532 /* Keep the remaining values connected, accummulating links
2533 in the canonical value. */
2534 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2536 if (node
->loc
== cval
)
2538 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
2539 var_reg_decl_set (set
, node
->loc
, node
->init
, cdv
, 0,
2540 node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2541 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == MEM
)
2542 var_mem_decl_set (set
, node
->loc
, node
->init
, cdv
, 0,
2543 node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2545 set_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, cdv
, 0,
2546 node
->init
, node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2550 /* We remove this last, to make sure that the canonical value is not
2551 removed to the point of requiring reinsertion. */
2553 delete_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (dv
), dv_from_value (cval
), 0);
2555 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv
, 0, NULL
);
2558 /* Find the values in a given location and map the val to another
2559 value, if it is unique, or add the location as one holding the
2563 val_resolve (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx val
, rtx loc
, rtx insn
)
2565 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_value (val
);
2567 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
2570 fprintf (dump_file
, "%i: ", INSN_UID (insn
));
2572 fprintf (dump_file
, "head: ");
2573 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, val
, 0);
2574 fputs (" is at ", dump_file
);
2575 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, loc
, 0);
2576 fputc ('\n', dump_file
);
2579 val_reset (set
, dv
);
2581 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc
));
2585 attrs node
, found
= NULL
;
2587 for (node
= set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)]; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2588 if (dv_is_value_p (node
->dv
)
2589 && GET_MODE (dv_as_value (node
->dv
)) == GET_MODE (loc
))
2593 /* Map incoming equivalences. ??? Wouldn't it be nice if
2594 we just started sharing the location lists? Maybe a
2595 circular list ending at the value itself or some
2597 set_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (node
->dv
),
2598 dv_from_value (val
), node
->offset
,
2599 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2600 set_variable_part (set
, val
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
,
2601 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2604 /* If we didn't find any equivalence, we need to remember that
2605 this value is held in the named register. */
2609 /* ??? Attempt to find and merge equivalent MEMs or other
2612 val_bind (set
, val
, loc
, false);
2615 /* Initialize dataflow set SET to be empty.
2616 VARS_SIZE is the initial size of hash table VARS. */
2619 dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set
*set
)
2621 init_attrs_list_set (set
->regs
);
2622 set
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash
);
2623 set
->stack_adjust
= 0;
2624 set
->traversed_vars
= NULL
;
2627 /* Delete the contents of dataflow set SET. */
2630 dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set
*set
)
2634 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
2635 attrs_list_clear (&set
->regs
[i
]);
2637 shared_hash_destroy (set
->vars
);
2638 set
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash
);
2641 /* Copy the contents of dataflow set SRC to DST. */
2644 dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set
*dst
, dataflow_set
*src
)
2648 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
2649 attrs_list_copy (&dst
->regs
[i
], src
->regs
[i
]);
2651 shared_hash_destroy (dst
->vars
);
2652 dst
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (src
->vars
);
2653 dst
->stack_adjust
= src
->stack_adjust
;
2656 /* Information for merging lists of locations for a given offset of variable.
2658 struct variable_union_info
2660 /* Node of the location chain. */
2663 /* The sum of positions in the input chains. */
2666 /* The position in the chain of DST dataflow set. */
2670 /* Buffer for location list sorting and its allocated size. */
2671 static struct variable_union_info
*vui_vec
;
2672 static int vui_allocated
;
2674 /* Compare function for qsort, order the structures by POS element. */
2677 variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *n1
, const void *n2
)
2679 const struct variable_union_info
*const i1
=
2680 (const struct variable_union_info
*) n1
;
2681 const struct variable_union_info
*const i2
=
2682 ( const struct variable_union_info
*) n2
;
2684 if (i1
->pos
!= i2
->pos
)
2685 return i1
->pos
- i2
->pos
;
2687 return (i1
->pos_dst
- i2
->pos_dst
);
2690 /* Compute union of location parts of variable *SLOT and the same variable
2691 from hash table DATA. Compute "sorted" union of the location chains
2692 for common offsets, i.e. the locations of a variable part are sorted by
2693 a priority where the priority is the sum of the positions in the 2 chains
2694 (if a location is only in one list the position in the second list is
2695 defined to be larger than the length of the chains).
2696 When we are updating the location parts the newest location is in the
2697 beginning of the chain, so when we do the described "sorted" union
2698 we keep the newest locations in the beginning. */
2701 variable_union (variable src
, dataflow_set
*set
)
2707 dstp
= shared_hash_find_slot (set
->vars
, src
->dv
);
2708 if (!dstp
|| !*dstp
)
2712 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
2714 dstp
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, src
->dv
, INSERT
);
2718 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
2722 dst
= (variable
) *dstp
;
2724 gcc_assert (src
->n_var_parts
);
2725 gcc_checking_assert (src
->onepart
== dst
->onepart
);
2727 /* We can combine one-part variables very efficiently, because their
2728 entries are in canonical order. */
2731 location_chain
*nodep
, dnode
, snode
;
2733 gcc_assert (src
->n_var_parts
== 1
2734 && dst
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2736 snode
= src
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
2739 restart_onepart_unshared
:
2740 nodep
= &dst
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
2746 int r
= dnode
? loc_cmp (dnode
->loc
, snode
->loc
) : 1;
2750 location_chain nnode
;
2752 if (shared_var_p (dst
, set
->vars
))
2754 dstp
= unshare_variable (set
, dstp
, dst
,
2755 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
2756 dst
= (variable
)*dstp
;
2757 goto restart_onepart_unshared
;
2760 *nodep
= nnode
= (location_chain
) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool
);
2761 nnode
->loc
= snode
->loc
;
2762 nnode
->init
= snode
->init
;
2763 if (!snode
->set_src
|| MEM_P (snode
->set_src
))
2764 nnode
->set_src
= NULL
;
2766 nnode
->set_src
= snode
->set_src
;
2767 nnode
->next
= dnode
;
2771 gcc_checking_assert (rtx_equal_p (dnode
->loc
, snode
->loc
));
2774 snode
= snode
->next
;
2776 nodep
= &dnode
->next
;
2783 gcc_checking_assert (!src
->onepart
);
2785 /* Count the number of location parts, result is K. */
2786 for (i
= 0, j
= 0, k
= 0;
2787 i
< src
->n_var_parts
&& j
< dst
->n_var_parts
; k
++)
2789 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
2794 else if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
2799 k
+= src
->n_var_parts
- i
;
2800 k
+= dst
->n_var_parts
- j
;
2802 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
2803 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
2804 gcc_checking_assert (dst
->onepart
? k
== 1 : k
<= MAX_VAR_PARTS
);
2806 if (dst
->n_var_parts
!= k
&& shared_var_p (dst
, set
->vars
))
2808 dstp
= unshare_variable (set
, dstp
, dst
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
2809 dst
= (variable
)*dstp
;
2812 i
= src
->n_var_parts
- 1;
2813 j
= dst
->n_var_parts
- 1;
2814 dst
->n_var_parts
= k
;
2816 for (k
--; k
>= 0; k
--)
2818 location_chain node
, node2
;
2820 if (i
>= 0 && j
>= 0
2821 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
2823 /* Compute the "sorted" union of the chains, i.e. the locations which
2824 are in both chains go first, they are sorted by the sum of
2825 positions in the chains. */
2828 struct variable_union_info
*vui
;
2830 /* If DST is shared compare the location chains.
2831 If they are different we will modify the chain in DST with
2832 high probability so make a copy of DST. */
2833 if (shared_var_p (dst
, set
->vars
))
2835 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
,
2836 node2
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
; node
&& node2
;
2837 node
= node
->next
, node2
= node2
->next
)
2839 if (!((REG_P (node2
->loc
)
2840 && REG_P (node
->loc
)
2841 && REGNO (node2
->loc
) == REGNO (node
->loc
))
2842 || rtx_equal_p (node2
->loc
, node
->loc
)))
2844 if (node2
->init
< node
->init
)
2845 node2
->init
= node
->init
;
2851 dstp
= unshare_variable (set
, dstp
, dst
,
2852 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
2853 dst
= (variable
)*dstp
;
2858 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2861 for (node
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2866 /* The most common case, much simpler, no qsort is needed. */
2867 location_chain dstnode
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
;
2868 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= dstnode
;
2869 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, k
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET(dst
, j
);
2871 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2872 if (!((REG_P (dstnode
->loc
)
2873 && REG_P (node
->loc
)
2874 && REGNO (dstnode
->loc
) == REGNO (node
->loc
))
2875 || rtx_equal_p (dstnode
->loc
, node
->loc
)))
2877 location_chain new_node
;
2879 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
2880 new_node
= (location_chain
) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool
);
2881 new_node
->loc
= node
->loc
;
2882 new_node
->init
= node
->init
;
2883 if (!node
->set_src
|| MEM_P (node
->set_src
))
2884 new_node
->set_src
= NULL
;
2886 new_node
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
2887 node2
->next
= new_node
;
2894 if (src_l
+ dst_l
> vui_allocated
)
2896 vui_allocated
= MAX (vui_allocated
* 2, src_l
+ dst_l
);
2897 vui_vec
= XRESIZEVEC (struct variable_union_info
, vui_vec
,
2902 /* Fill in the locations from DST. */
2903 for (node
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
, jj
= 0; node
;
2904 node
= node
->next
, jj
++)
2907 vui
[jj
].pos_dst
= jj
;
2909 /* Pos plus value larger than a sum of 2 valid positions. */
2910 vui
[jj
].pos
= jj
+ src_l
+ dst_l
;
2913 /* Fill in the locations from SRC. */
2915 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
, ii
= 0; node
;
2916 node
= node
->next
, ii
++)
2918 /* Find location from NODE. */
2919 for (jj
= 0; jj
< dst_l
; jj
++)
2921 if ((REG_P (vui
[jj
].lc
->loc
)
2922 && REG_P (node
->loc
)
2923 && REGNO (vui
[jj
].lc
->loc
) == REGNO (node
->loc
))
2924 || rtx_equal_p (vui
[jj
].lc
->loc
, node
->loc
))
2926 vui
[jj
].pos
= jj
+ ii
;
2930 if (jj
>= dst_l
) /* The location has not been found. */
2932 location_chain new_node
;
2934 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
2935 new_node
= (location_chain
) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool
);
2936 new_node
->loc
= node
->loc
;
2937 new_node
->init
= node
->init
;
2938 if (!node
->set_src
|| MEM_P (node
->set_src
))
2939 new_node
->set_src
= NULL
;
2941 new_node
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
2942 vui
[n
].lc
= new_node
;
2943 vui
[n
].pos_dst
= src_l
+ dst_l
;
2944 vui
[n
].pos
= ii
+ src_l
+ dst_l
;
2951 /* Special case still very common case. For dst_l == 2
2952 all entries dst_l ... n-1 are sorted, with for i >= dst_l
2953 vui[i].pos == i + src_l + dst_l. */
2954 if (vui
[0].pos
> vui
[1].pos
)
2956 /* Order should be 1, 0, 2... */
2957 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= vui
[1].lc
;
2958 vui
[1].lc
->next
= vui
[0].lc
;
2961 vui
[0].lc
->next
= vui
[2].lc
;
2962 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
2965 vui
[0].lc
->next
= NULL
;
2970 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= vui
[0].lc
;
2971 if (n
>= 3 && vui
[2].pos
< vui
[1].pos
)
2973 /* Order should be 0, 2, 1, 3... */
2974 vui
[0].lc
->next
= vui
[2].lc
;
2975 vui
[2].lc
->next
= vui
[1].lc
;
2978 vui
[1].lc
->next
= vui
[3].lc
;
2979 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
2982 vui
[1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
2987 /* Order should be 0, 1, 2... */
2989 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
2992 for (; ii
< n
; ii
++)
2993 vui
[ii
- 1].lc
->next
= vui
[ii
].lc
;
2997 qsort (vui
, n
, sizeof (struct variable_union_info
),
2998 variable_union_info_cmp_pos
);
3000 /* Reconnect the nodes in sorted order. */
3001 for (ii
= 1; ii
< n
; ii
++)
3002 vui
[ii
- 1].lc
->next
= vui
[ii
].lc
;
3003 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
3004 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= vui
[0].lc
;
3007 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, k
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
);
3012 else if ((i
>= 0 && j
>= 0
3013 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
3016 dst
->var_part
[k
] = dst
->var_part
[j
];
3019 else if ((i
>= 0 && j
>= 0
3020 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) > VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
3023 location_chain
*nextp
;
3025 /* Copy the chain from SRC. */
3026 nextp
= &dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
;
3027 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3029 location_chain new_lc
;
3031 new_lc
= (location_chain
) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool
);
3032 new_lc
->next
= NULL
;
3033 new_lc
->init
= node
->init
;
3034 if (!node
->set_src
|| MEM_P (node
->set_src
))
3035 new_lc
->set_src
= NULL
;
3037 new_lc
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
3038 new_lc
->loc
= node
->loc
;
3041 nextp
= &new_lc
->next
;
3044 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, k
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
);
3047 dst
->var_part
[k
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
3050 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
3051 for (i
= 0; i
< src
->n_var_parts
&& i
< dst
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
3053 location_chain node
, node2
;
3054 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3055 for (node2
= dst
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node2
; node2
= node2
->next
)
3056 if (rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, node2
->loc
))
3058 if (node
->init
> node2
->init
)
3059 node2
->init
= node
->init
;
3063 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
3067 /* Compute union of dataflow sets SRC and DST and store it to DST. */
3070 dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set
*dst
, dataflow_set
*src
)
3074 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
3075 attrs_list_union (&dst
->regs
[i
], src
->regs
[i
]);
3077 if (dst
->vars
== empty_shared_hash
)
3079 shared_hash_destroy (dst
->vars
);
3080 dst
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (src
->vars
);
3087 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (src
->vars
), var
, variable
, hi
)
3088 variable_union (var
, dst
);
3092 /* Whether the value is currently being expanded. */
3093 #define VALUE_RECURSED_INTO(x) \
3094 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("VALUE_RECURSED_INTO", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->used)
3096 /* Whether no expansion was found, saving useless lookups.
3097 It must only be set when VALUE_CHANGED is clear. */
3098 #define NO_LOC_P(x) \
3099 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("NO_LOC_P", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->return_val)
3101 /* Whether cur_loc in the value needs to be (re)computed. */
3102 #define VALUE_CHANGED(x) \
3103 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VALUE_CHANGED", (x), VALUE)->frame_related)
3104 /* Whether cur_loc in the decl needs to be (re)computed. */
3105 #define DECL_CHANGED(x) TREE_VISITED (x)
3107 /* Record (if NEWV) that DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. For
3108 user DECLs, this means they're in changed_variables. Values and
3109 debug exprs may be left with this flag set if no user variable
3110 requires them to be evaluated. */
3113 set_dv_changed (decl_or_value dv
, bool newv
)
3115 switch (dv_onepart_p (dv
))
3119 NO_LOC_P (dv_as_value (dv
)) = false;
3120 VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv
)) = newv
;
3125 NO_LOC_P (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (dv
))) = false;
3126 /* Fall through... */
3129 DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv
)) = newv
;
3134 /* Return true if DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. */
3137 dv_changed_p (decl_or_value dv
)
3139 return (dv_is_value_p (dv
)
3140 ? VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv
))
3141 : DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv
)));
3144 /* Return a location list node whose loc is rtx_equal to LOC, in the
3145 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
3146 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. VARS must
3147 be in star-canonical form. */
3149 static location_chain
3150 find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx loc
, variable var
, htab_t vars
)
3152 location_chain node
;
3153 enum rtx_code loc_code
;
3158 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
);
3160 if (!var
->n_var_parts
)
3163 gcc_checking_assert (loc
!= dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
));
3165 loc_code
= GET_CODE (loc
);
3166 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3171 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) != loc_code
)
3173 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) != VALUE
)
3176 else if (loc
== node
->loc
)
3178 else if (loc_code
!= VALUE
)
3180 if (rtx_equal_p (loc
, node
->loc
))
3185 /* Since we're in star-canonical form, we don't need to visit
3186 non-canonical nodes: one-part variables and non-canonical
3187 values would only point back to the canonical node. */
3188 if (dv_is_value_p (var
->dv
)
3189 && !canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, dv_as_value (var
->dv
)))
3191 /* Skip all subsequent VALUEs. */
3192 while (node
->next
&& GET_CODE (node
->next
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3195 gcc_checking_assert (!canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
,
3196 dv_as_value (var
->dv
)));
3197 if (loc
== node
->loc
)
3203 gcc_checking_assert (node
== var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
);
3204 gcc_checking_assert (!node
->next
);
3206 dv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
3207 rvar
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
3208 return find_loc_in_1pdv (loc
, rvar
, vars
);
3211 /* ??? Gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
3216 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_merge. */
3219 /* The set in which the merge is to be inserted. */
3221 /* The set that we're iterating in. */
3223 /* The set that may contain the other dv we are to merge with. */
3225 /* Number of onepart dvs in src. */
3226 int src_onepart_cnt
;
3229 /* Insert LOC in *DNODE, if it's not there yet. The list must be in
3230 loc_cmp order, and it is maintained as such. */
3233 insert_into_intersection (location_chain
*nodep
, rtx loc
,
3234 enum var_init_status status
)
3236 location_chain node
;
3239 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; nodep
= &node
->next
, node
= *nodep
)
3240 if ((r
= loc_cmp (node
->loc
, loc
)) == 0)
3242 node
->init
= MIN (node
->init
, status
);
3248 node
= (location_chain
) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool
);
3251 node
->set_src
= NULL
;
3252 node
->init
= status
;
3253 node
->next
= *nodep
;
3257 /* Insert in DEST the intersection of the locations present in both
3258 S1NODE and S2VAR, directly or indirectly. S1NODE is from a
3259 variable in DSM->cur, whereas S2VAR is from DSM->src. dvar is in
3263 intersect_loc_chains (rtx val
, location_chain
*dest
, struct dfset_merge
*dsm
,
3264 location_chain s1node
, variable s2var
)
3266 dataflow_set
*s1set
= dsm
->cur
;
3267 dataflow_set
*s2set
= dsm
->src
;
3268 location_chain found
;
3272 location_chain s2node
;
3274 gcc_checking_assert (s2var
->onepart
);
3276 if (s2var
->n_var_parts
)
3278 s2node
= s2var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3280 for (; s1node
&& s2node
;
3281 s1node
= s1node
->next
, s2node
= s2node
->next
)
3282 if (s1node
->loc
!= s2node
->loc
)
3284 else if (s1node
->loc
== val
)
3287 insert_into_intersection (dest
, s1node
->loc
,
3288 MIN (s1node
->init
, s2node
->init
));
3292 for (; s1node
; s1node
= s1node
->next
)
3294 if (s1node
->loc
== val
)
3297 if ((found
= find_loc_in_1pdv (s1node
->loc
, s2var
,
3298 shared_hash_htab (s2set
->vars
))))
3300 insert_into_intersection (dest
, s1node
->loc
,
3301 MIN (s1node
->init
, found
->init
));
3305 if (GET_CODE (s1node
->loc
) == VALUE
3306 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node
->loc
))
3308 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_value (s1node
->loc
);
3309 variable svar
= shared_hash_find (s1set
->vars
, dv
);
3312 if (svar
->n_var_parts
== 1)
3314 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node
->loc
) = true;
3315 intersect_loc_chains (val
, dest
, dsm
,
3316 svar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
,
3318 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node
->loc
) = false;
3323 /* ??? gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
3325 /* ??? if the location is equivalent to any location in src,
3326 searched recursively
3328 add to dst the values needed to represent the equivalence
3330 telling whether locations S is equivalent to another dv's
3333 for each location D in the list
3335 if S and D satisfy rtx_equal_p, then it is present
3337 else if D is a value, recurse without cycles
3339 else if S and D have the same CODE and MODE
3341 for each operand oS and the corresponding oD
3343 if oS and oD are not equivalent, then S an D are not equivalent
3345 else if they are RTX vectors
3347 if any vector oS element is not equivalent to its respective oD,
3348 then S and D are not equivalent
3356 /* Return -1 if X should be before Y in a location list for a 1-part
3357 variable, 1 if Y should be before X, and 0 if they're equivalent
3358 and should not appear in the list. */
3361 loc_cmp (rtx x
, rtx y
)
3364 RTX_CODE code
= GET_CODE (x
);
3374 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3375 if (REGNO (x
) == REGNO (y
))
3377 else if (REGNO (x
) < REGNO (y
))
3390 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3391 return loc_cmp (XEXP (x
, 0), XEXP (y
, 0));
3397 if (GET_CODE (x
) == VALUE
)
3399 if (GET_CODE (y
) != VALUE
)
3401 /* Don't assert the modes are the same, that is true only
3402 when not recursing. (subreg:QI (value:SI 1:1) 0)
3403 and (subreg:QI (value:DI 2:2) 0) can be compared,
3404 even when the modes are different. */
3405 if (canon_value_cmp (x
, y
))
3411 if (GET_CODE (y
) == VALUE
)
3414 /* Entry value is the least preferable kind of expression. */
3415 if (GET_CODE (x
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
3417 if (GET_CODE (y
) != ENTRY_VALUE
)
3419 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3420 return loc_cmp (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (x
), ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (y
));
3423 if (GET_CODE (y
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
3426 if (GET_CODE (x
) == GET_CODE (y
))
3427 /* Compare operands below. */;
3428 else if (GET_CODE (x
) < GET_CODE (y
))
3433 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3435 if (GET_CODE (x
) == DEBUG_EXPR
)
3437 if (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
))
3438 < DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y
)))
3440 gcc_checking_assert (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
))
3441 > DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y
)));
3445 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
3446 for (i
= 0; i
< GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
); i
++)
3450 if (XWINT (x
, i
) == XWINT (y
, i
))
3452 else if (XWINT (x
, i
) < XWINT (y
, i
))
3459 if (XINT (x
, i
) == XINT (y
, i
))
3461 else if (XINT (x
, i
) < XINT (y
, i
))
3468 /* Compare the vector length first. */
3469 if (XVECLEN (x
, i
) == XVECLEN (y
, i
))
3470 /* Compare the vectors elements. */;
3471 else if (XVECLEN (x
, i
) < XVECLEN (y
, i
))
3476 for (j
= 0; j
< XVECLEN (x
, i
); j
++)
3477 if ((r
= loc_cmp (XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
),
3478 XVECEXP (y
, i
, j
))))
3483 if ((r
= loc_cmp (XEXP (x
, i
), XEXP (y
, i
))))
3489 if (XSTR (x
, i
) == XSTR (y
, i
))
3495 if ((r
= strcmp (XSTR (x
, i
), XSTR (y
, i
))) == 0)
3503 /* These are just backpointers, so they don't matter. */
3510 /* It is believed that rtx's at this level will never
3511 contain anything but integers and other rtx's,
3512 except for within LABEL_REFs and SYMBOL_REFs. */
3521 /* Check the order of entries in one-part variables. */
3524 canonicalize_loc_order_check (void **slot
, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
3526 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
3527 location_chain node
, next
;
3529 #ifdef ENABLE_RTL_CHECKING
3531 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
3532 gcc_assert (var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
== NULL
);
3533 gcc_assert (!var
->in_changed_variables
);
3539 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3540 node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3543 while ((next
= node
->next
))
3545 gcc_assert (loc_cmp (node
->loc
, next
->loc
) < 0);
3553 /* Mark with VALUE_RECURSED_INTO values that have neighbors that are
3554 more likely to be chosen as canonical for an equivalence set.
3555 Ensure less likely values can reach more likely neighbors, making
3556 the connections bidirectional. */
3559 canonicalize_values_mark (void **slot
, void *data
)
3561 dataflow_set
*set
= (dataflow_set
*)data
;
3562 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
3563 decl_or_value dv
= var
->dv
;
3565 location_chain node
;
3567 if (!dv_is_value_p (dv
))
3570 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3572 val
= dv_as_value (dv
);
3574 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3575 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3577 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, val
))
3578 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
3581 decl_or_value odv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
3582 void **oslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, odv
);
3584 set_slot_part (set
, val
, oslot
, odv
, 0,
3585 node
->init
, NULL_RTX
);
3587 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
3594 /* Remove redundant entries from equivalence lists in onepart
3595 variables, canonicalizing equivalence sets into star shapes. */
3598 canonicalize_values_star (void **slot
, void *data
)
3600 dataflow_set
*set
= (dataflow_set
*)data
;
3601 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
3602 decl_or_value dv
= var
->dv
;
3603 location_chain node
;
3613 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3615 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
3617 cval
= dv_as_value (dv
);
3618 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
))
3620 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = false;
3630 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3632 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3633 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3636 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
3638 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, cval
))
3647 if (!has_marks
|| dv_is_decl_p (dv
))
3650 /* Keep it marked so that we revisit it, either after visiting a
3651 child node, or after visiting a new parent that might be
3653 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
3655 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3656 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
3657 && VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
3661 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = false;
3662 dv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
3663 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
3666 gcc_assert (dv_is_decl_p (var
->dv
));
3667 /* The canonical value was reset and dropped.
3669 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, var
->dv
, 0, NULL
);
3672 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
3673 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (var
->dv
));
3674 if (var
->n_var_parts
== 0)
3676 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3680 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = false;
3685 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3686 cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
3687 cslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, cdv
);
3689 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3690 if (node
->loc
!= cval
)
3692 cslot
= set_slot_part (set
, node
->loc
, cslot
, cdv
, 0,
3693 node
->init
, NULL_RTX
);
3694 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3696 decl_or_value ndv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
3698 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, ndv
, 0, node
->init
, NULL_RTX
,
3701 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, val
))
3703 /* If it could have been a local minimum, it's not any more,
3704 since it's now neighbor to cval, so it may have to push
3705 to it. Conversely, if it wouldn't have prevailed over
3706 val, then whatever mark it has is fine: if it was to
3707 push, it will now push to a more canonical node, but if
3708 it wasn't, then it has already pushed any values it might
3710 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
3711 /* Make sure we visit node->loc by ensuring we cval is
3713 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = true;
3715 else if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
3716 /* If we have no need to "recurse" into this node, it's
3717 already "canonicalized", so drop the link to the old
3719 clobber_variable_part (set
, cval
, ndv
, 0, NULL
);
3721 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
3723 attrs list
= set
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)], *listp
;
3725 /* Change an existing attribute referring to dv so that it
3726 refers to cdv, removing any duplicate this might
3727 introduce, and checking that no previous duplicates
3728 existed, all in a single pass. */
3732 if (list
->offset
== 0
3733 && (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
)
3734 || dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
)))
3741 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
))
3744 for (listp
= &list
->next
; (list
= *listp
); listp
= &list
->next
)
3749 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
))
3751 *listp
= list
->next
;
3752 pool_free (attrs_pool
, list
);
3757 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) != dv_as_opaque (dv
));
3760 else if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
))
3762 for (listp
= &list
->next
; (list
= *listp
); listp
= &list
->next
)
3767 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
))
3769 *listp
= list
->next
;
3770 pool_free (attrs_pool
, list
);
3775 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) != dv_as_opaque (cdv
));
3784 if (list
->offset
== 0
3785 && (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
)
3786 || dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
)))
3796 set_slot_part (set
, val
, cslot
, cdv
, 0,
3797 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
);
3799 slot
= clobber_slot_part (set
, cval
, slot
, 0, NULL
);
3801 /* Variable may have been unshared. */
3802 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
3803 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
&& var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
->loc
== cval
3804 && var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
->next
== NULL
);
3806 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
))
3807 goto restart_with_cval
;
3812 /* Bind one-part variables to the canonical value in an equivalence
3813 set. Not doing this causes dataflow convergence failure in rare
3814 circumstances, see PR42873. Unfortunately we can't do this
3815 efficiently as part of canonicalize_values_star, since we may not
3816 have determined or even seen the canonical value of a set when we
3817 get to a variable that references another member of the set. */
3820 canonicalize_vars_star (void **slot
, void *data
)
3822 dataflow_set
*set
= (dataflow_set
*)data
;
3823 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
3824 decl_or_value dv
= var
->dv
;
3825 location_chain node
;
3830 location_chain cnode
;
3832 if (!var
->onepart
|| var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
3835 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3837 node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3839 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) != VALUE
)
3842 gcc_assert (!node
->next
);
3845 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3846 cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
3847 cslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, cdv
);
3850 cvar
= (variable
)*cslot
;
3851 gcc_assert (cvar
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3853 cnode
= cvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3855 /* CVAL is canonical if its value list contains non-VALUEs or VALUEs
3856 that are not “more canonical” than it. */
3857 if (GET_CODE (cnode
->loc
) != VALUE
3858 || !canon_value_cmp (cnode
->loc
, cval
))
3861 /* CVAL was found to be non-canonical. Change the variable to point
3862 to the canonical VALUE. */
3863 gcc_assert (!cnode
->next
);
3866 slot
= set_slot_part (set
, cval
, slot
, dv
, 0,
3867 node
->init
, node
->set_src
);
3868 clobber_slot_part (set
, cval
, slot
, 0, node
->set_src
);
3873 /* Combine variable or value in *S1SLOT (in DSM->cur) with the
3874 corresponding entry in DSM->src. Multi-part variables are combined
3875 with variable_union, whereas onepart dvs are combined with
3879 variable_merge_over_cur (variable s1var
, struct dfset_merge
*dsm
)
3881 dataflow_set
*dst
= dsm
->dst
;
3883 variable s2var
, dvar
= NULL
;
3884 decl_or_value dv
= s1var
->dv
;
3885 onepart_enum_t onepart
= s1var
->onepart
;
3888 location_chain node
, *nodep
;
3890 /* If the incoming onepart variable has an empty location list, then
3891 the intersection will be just as empty. For other variables,
3892 it's always union. */
3893 gcc_checking_assert (s1var
->n_var_parts
3894 && s1var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
);
3897 return variable_union (s1var
, dst
);
3899 gcc_checking_assert (s1var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3901 dvhash
= dv_htab_hash (dv
);
3902 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
3903 val
= dv_as_value (dv
);
3907 s2var
= shared_hash_find_1 (dsm
->src
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
3910 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
3914 dsm
->src_onepart_cnt
--;
3915 gcc_assert (s2var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
3916 && s2var
->onepart
== onepart
3917 && s2var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3919 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
3922 dvar
= (variable
)*dstslot
;
3923 gcc_assert (dvar
->refcount
== 1
3924 && dvar
->onepart
== onepart
3925 && dvar
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3926 nodep
= &dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3934 if (!dstslot
&& !onepart_variable_different_p (s1var
, s2var
))
3936 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst
->vars
, dv
,
3938 *dstslot
= dvar
= s2var
;
3943 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
3945 intersect_loc_chains (val
, nodep
, dsm
,
3946 s1var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, s2var
);
3952 dvar
= (variable
) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart
));
3955 dvar
->n_var_parts
= 1;
3956 dvar
->onepart
= onepart
;
3957 dvar
->in_changed_variables
= false;
3958 dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= node
;
3959 dvar
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
3961 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar
) = NULL
;
3963 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dvar
, 0) = 0;
3966 = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
,
3968 gcc_assert (!*dstslot
);
3976 nodep
= &dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3977 while ((node
= *nodep
))
3979 location_chain
*nextp
= &node
->next
;
3981 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
3985 for (list
= dst
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)]; list
; list
= list
->next
)
3986 if (GET_MODE (node
->loc
) == GET_MODE (list
->loc
)
3987 && dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
3991 attrs_list_insert (&dst
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)],
3993 /* If this value became canonical for another value that had
3994 this register, we want to leave it alone. */
3995 else if (dv_as_value (list
->dv
) != val
)
3997 dstslot
= set_slot_part (dst
, dv_as_value (list
->dv
),
3999 node
->init
, NULL_RTX
);
4000 dstslot
= delete_slot_part (dst
, node
->loc
, dstslot
, 0);
4002 /* Since nextp points into the removed node, we can't
4003 use it. The pointer to the next node moved to nodep.
4004 However, if the variable we're walking is unshared
4005 during our walk, we'll keep walking the location list
4006 of the previously-shared variable, in which case the
4007 node won't have been removed, and we'll want to skip
4008 it. That's why we test *nodep here. */
4014 /* Canonicalization puts registers first, so we don't have to
4020 if (dvar
!= (variable
)*dstslot
)
4021 dvar
= (variable
)*dstslot
;
4022 nodep
= &dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4026 /* Mark all referenced nodes for canonicalization, and make sure
4027 we have mutual equivalence links. */
4028 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
4029 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4030 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4032 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
4033 set_variable_part (dst
, val
, dv_from_value (node
->loc
), 0,
4034 node
->init
, NULL
, INSERT
);
4037 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
4038 gcc_assert (*dstslot
== dvar
);
4039 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot
, dst
);
4040 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
4041 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
,
4043 dvar
= (variable
)*dstslot
;
4047 bool has_value
= false, has_other
= false;
4049 /* If we have one value and anything else, we're going to
4050 canonicalize this, so make sure all values have an entry in
4051 the table and are marked for canonicalization. */
4052 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4054 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4056 /* If this was marked during register canonicalization,
4057 we know we have to canonicalize values. */
4072 if (has_value
&& has_other
)
4074 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4076 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4078 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
4081 if (shared_hash_shared (dst
->vars
))
4082 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (dst
->vars
, dv
);
4084 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&dst
->vars
, dv
,
4088 variable var
= (variable
) pool_alloc (onepart_pool
4092 var
->n_var_parts
= 1;
4093 var
->onepart
= ONEPART_VALUE
;
4094 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
4095 var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
4096 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4097 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
4101 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
4105 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
4106 gcc_assert (*dstslot
== dvar
);
4107 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot
, dst
);
4108 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
4109 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
,
4111 dvar
= (variable
)*dstslot
;
4115 if (!onepart_variable_different_p (dvar
, s2var
))
4117 variable_htab_free (dvar
);
4118 *dstslot
= dvar
= s2var
;
4121 else if (s2var
!= s1var
&& !onepart_variable_different_p (dvar
, s1var
))
4123 variable_htab_free (dvar
);
4124 *dstslot
= dvar
= s1var
;
4126 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4129 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4134 /* Copy s2slot (in DSM->src) to DSM->dst if the variable is a
4135 multi-part variable. Unions of multi-part variables and
4136 intersections of one-part ones will be handled in
4137 variable_merge_over_cur(). */
4140 variable_merge_over_src (variable s2var
, struct dfset_merge
*dsm
)
4142 dataflow_set
*dst
= dsm
->dst
;
4143 decl_or_value dv
= s2var
->dv
;
4145 if (!s2var
->onepart
)
4147 void **dstp
= shared_hash_find_slot (dst
->vars
, dv
);
4153 dsm
->src_onepart_cnt
++;
4157 /* Combine dataflow set information from SRC2 into DST, using PDST
4158 to carry over information across passes. */
4161 dataflow_set_merge (dataflow_set
*dst
, dataflow_set
*src2
)
4163 dataflow_set cur
= *dst
;
4164 dataflow_set
*src1
= &cur
;
4165 struct dfset_merge dsm
;
4167 size_t src1_elems
, src2_elems
;
4171 src1_elems
= htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (src1
->vars
));
4172 src2_elems
= htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (src2
->vars
));
4173 dataflow_set_init (dst
);
4174 dst
->stack_adjust
= cur
.stack_adjust
;
4175 shared_hash_destroy (dst
->vars
);
4176 dst
->vars
= (shared_hash
) pool_alloc (shared_hash_pool
);
4177 dst
->vars
->refcount
= 1;
4179 = htab_create (MAX (src1_elems
, src2_elems
), variable_htab_hash
,
4180 variable_htab_eq
, variable_htab_free
);
4182 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
4183 attrs_list_mpdv_union (&dst
->regs
[i
], src1
->regs
[i
], src2
->regs
[i
]);
4188 dsm
.src_onepart_cnt
= 0;
4190 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (dsm
.src
->vars
), var
, variable
, hi
)
4191 variable_merge_over_src (var
, &dsm
);
4192 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (dsm
.cur
->vars
), var
, variable
, hi
)
4193 variable_merge_over_cur (var
, &dsm
);
4195 if (dsm
.src_onepart_cnt
)
4196 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4198 dataflow_set_destroy (src1
);
4201 /* Mark register equivalences. */
4204 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (dataflow_set
*set
)
4209 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
4211 rtx canon
[NUM_MACHINE_MODES
];
4213 /* If the list is empty or one entry, no need to canonicalize
4215 if (set
->regs
[i
] == NULL
|| set
->regs
[i
]->next
== NULL
)
4218 memset (canon
, 0, sizeof (canon
));
4220 for (list
= set
->regs
[i
]; list
; list
= list
->next
)
4221 if (list
->offset
== 0 && dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
4223 rtx val
= dv_as_value (list
->dv
);
4224 rtx
*cvalp
= &canon
[(int)GET_MODE (val
)];
4227 if (canon_value_cmp (val
, cval
))
4231 for (list
= set
->regs
[i
]; list
; list
= list
->next
)
4232 if (list
->offset
== 0 && dv_onepart_p (list
->dv
))
4234 rtx cval
= canon
[(int)GET_MODE (list
->loc
)];
4239 if (dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
4241 rtx val
= dv_as_value (list
->dv
);
4246 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
4247 set_variable_part (set
, val
, dv_from_value (cval
), 0,
4248 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
4252 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = true;
4253 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, list
->dv
, 0,
4254 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, NO_INSERT
);
4257 for (listp
= &set
->regs
[i
]; (list
= *listp
);
4258 listp
= list
? &list
->next
: listp
)
4259 if (list
->offset
== 0 && dv_onepart_p (list
->dv
))
4261 rtx cval
= canon
[(int)GET_MODE (list
->loc
)];
4267 if (dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
4269 rtx val
= dv_as_value (list
->dv
);
4270 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
))
4274 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, list
->dv
);
4275 canonicalize_values_star (slot
, set
);
4282 /* Remove any redundant values in the location list of VAR, which must
4283 be unshared and 1-part. */
4286 remove_duplicate_values (variable var
)
4288 location_chain node
, *nodep
;
4290 gcc_assert (var
->onepart
);
4291 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4292 gcc_assert (var
->refcount
== 1);
4294 for (nodep
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nodep
); )
4296 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4298 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
4300 /* Remove duplicate value node. */
4301 *nodep
= node
->next
;
4302 pool_free (loc_chain_pool
, node
);
4306 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
4308 nodep
= &node
->next
;
4311 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4312 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4314 gcc_assert (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
));
4315 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = false;
4320 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_post_merge. */
4321 struct dfset_post_merge
4323 /* The new input set for the current block. */
4325 /* Pointer to the permanent input set for the current block, or
4327 dataflow_set
**permp
;
4330 /* Create values for incoming expressions associated with one-part
4331 variables that don't have value numbers for them. */
4334 variable_post_merge_new_vals (void **slot
, void *info
)
4336 struct dfset_post_merge
*dfpm
= (struct dfset_post_merge
*)info
;
4337 dataflow_set
*set
= dfpm
->set
;
4338 variable var
= (variable
)*slot
;
4339 location_chain node
;
4341 if (!var
->onepart
|| !var
->n_var_parts
)
4344 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4346 if (dv_is_decl_p (var
->dv
))
4348 bool check_dupes
= false;
4351 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4353 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4354 gcc_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
));
4355 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
4357 attrs att
, *attp
, *curp
= NULL
;
4359 if (var
->refcount
!= 1)
4361 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
,
4362 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
4363 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
4367 for (attp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)]; (att
= *attp
);
4369 if (att
->offset
== 0
4370 && GET_MODE (att
->loc
) == GET_MODE (node
->loc
))
4372 if (dv_is_value_p (att
->dv
))
4374 rtx cval
= dv_as_value (att
->dv
);
4379 else if (dv_as_opaque (att
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
))
4387 if ((*curp
)->offset
== 0
4388 && GET_MODE ((*curp
)->loc
) == GET_MODE (node
->loc
)
4389 && dv_as_opaque ((*curp
)->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
))
4392 curp
= &(*curp
)->next
;
4403 *dfpm
->permp
= XNEW (dataflow_set
);
4404 dataflow_set_init (*dfpm
->permp
);
4407 for (att
= (*dfpm
->permp
)->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)];
4408 att
; att
= att
->next
)
4409 if (GET_MODE (att
->loc
) == GET_MODE (node
->loc
))
4411 gcc_assert (att
->offset
== 0
4412 && dv_is_value_p (att
->dv
));
4413 val_reset (set
, att
->dv
);
4420 cval
= dv_as_value (cdv
);
4424 /* Create a unique value to hold this register,
4425 that ought to be found and reused in
4426 subsequent rounds. */
4428 gcc_assert (!cselib_lookup (node
->loc
,
4429 GET_MODE (node
->loc
), 0,
4431 v
= cselib_lookup (node
->loc
, GET_MODE (node
->loc
), 1,
4433 cselib_preserve_value (v
);
4434 cselib_invalidate_rtx (node
->loc
);
4436 cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
4439 "Created new value %u:%u for reg %i\n",
4440 v
->uid
, v
->hash
, REGNO (node
->loc
));
4443 var_reg_decl_set (*dfpm
->permp
, node
->loc
,
4444 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
4445 cdv
, 0, NULL
, INSERT
);
4451 /* Remove attribute referring to the decl, which now
4452 uses the value for the register, already existing or
4453 to be added when we bring perm in. */
4456 pool_free (attrs_pool
, att
);
4461 remove_duplicate_values (var
);
4467 /* Reset values in the permanent set that are not associated with the
4468 chosen expression. */
4471 variable_post_merge_perm_vals (void **pslot
, void *info
)
4473 struct dfset_post_merge
*dfpm
= (struct dfset_post_merge
*)info
;
4474 dataflow_set
*set
= dfpm
->set
;
4475 variable pvar
= (variable
)*pslot
, var
;
4476 location_chain pnode
;
4480 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (pvar
->dv
)
4481 && pvar
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4482 pnode
= pvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4485 && REG_P (pnode
->loc
));
4489 var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
);
4492 /* Although variable_post_merge_new_vals may have made decls
4493 non-star-canonical, values that pre-existed in canonical form
4494 remain canonical, and newly-created values reference a single
4495 REG, so they are canonical as well. Since VAR has the
4496 location list for a VALUE, using find_loc_in_1pdv for it is
4497 fine, since VALUEs don't map back to DECLs. */
4498 if (find_loc_in_1pdv (pnode
->loc
, var
, shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)))
4500 val_reset (set
, dv
);
4503 for (att
= set
->regs
[REGNO (pnode
->loc
)]; att
; att
= att
->next
)
4504 if (att
->offset
== 0
4505 && GET_MODE (att
->loc
) == GET_MODE (pnode
->loc
)
4506 && dv_is_value_p (att
->dv
))
4509 /* If there is a value associated with this register already, create
4511 if (att
&& dv_as_value (att
->dv
) != dv_as_value (dv
))
4513 rtx cval
= dv_as_value (att
->dv
);
4514 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, dv
, 0, pnode
->init
, NULL
, INSERT
);
4515 set_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (dv
), att
->dv
, 0, pnode
->init
,
4520 attrs_list_insert (&set
->regs
[REGNO (pnode
->loc
)],
4522 variable_union (pvar
, set
);
4528 /* Just checking stuff and registering register attributes for
4532 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (dataflow_set
*set
, dataflow_set
**permp
)
4534 struct dfset_post_merge dfpm
;
4539 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
), variable_post_merge_new_vals
,
4542 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab ((*permp
)->vars
),
4543 variable_post_merge_perm_vals
, &dfpm
);
4544 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
), canonicalize_values_star
, set
);
4545 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
), canonicalize_vars_star
, set
);
4548 /* Return a node whose loc is a MEM that refers to EXPR in the
4549 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
4550 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. */
4552 static location_chain
4553 find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (tree expr
, rtx val
, htab_t vars
)
4555 location_chain node
;
4558 location_chain where
= NULL
;
4563 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (val
) == VALUE
4564 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
));
4566 dv
= dv_from_value (val
);
4567 var
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
4572 gcc_assert (var
->onepart
);
4574 if (!var
->n_var_parts
)
4577 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
4579 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4580 if (MEM_P (node
->loc
)
4581 && MEM_EXPR (node
->loc
) == expr
4582 && INT_MEM_OFFSET (node
->loc
) == 0)
4587 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
4588 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
)
4589 && (where
= find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (expr
, node
->loc
, vars
)))
4592 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = false;
4597 /* Return TRUE if the value of MEM may vary across a call. */
4600 mem_dies_at_call (rtx mem
)
4602 tree expr
= MEM_EXPR (mem
);
4608 decl
= get_base_address (expr
);
4616 return (may_be_aliased (decl
)
4617 || (!TREE_READONLY (decl
) && is_global_var (decl
)));
4620 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4621 one-part variable, except those whose MEM attributes map back to
4622 the variable itself, directly or within a VALUE. */
4625 dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs (void **slot
, void *data
)
4627 dataflow_set
*set
= (dataflow_set
*) data
;
4628 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
4630 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VDECL
|| var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
4632 tree decl
= dv_as_decl (var
->dv
);
4633 location_chain loc
, *locp
;
4634 bool changed
= false;
4636 if (!var
->n_var_parts
)
4639 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4641 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
4643 for (loc
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
4645 /* We want to remove dying MEMs that doesn't refer to DECL. */
4646 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) == MEM
4647 && (MEM_EXPR (loc
->loc
) != decl
4648 || INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
->loc
) != 0)
4649 && !mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4651 /* We want to move here MEMs that do refer to DECL. */
4652 else if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) == VALUE
4653 && find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl
, loc
->loc
,
4654 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)))
4661 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
4662 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
4663 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4666 for (locp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, loc
= *locp
;
4669 rtx old_loc
= loc
->loc
;
4670 if (GET_CODE (old_loc
) == VALUE
)
4672 location_chain mem_node
4673 = find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl
, loc
->loc
,
4674 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
));
4676 /* ??? This picks up only one out of multiple MEMs that
4677 refer to the same variable. Do we ever need to be
4678 concerned about dealing with more than one, or, given
4679 that they should all map to the same variable
4680 location, their addresses will have been merged and
4681 they will be regarded as equivalent? */
4684 loc
->loc
= mem_node
->loc
;
4685 loc
->set_src
= mem_node
->set_src
;
4686 loc
->init
= MIN (loc
->init
, mem_node
->init
);
4690 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) != MEM
4691 || (MEM_EXPR (loc
->loc
) == decl
4692 && INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
->loc
) == 0)
4693 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4695 if (old_loc
!= loc
->loc
&& emit_notes
)
4697 if (old_loc
== var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
)
4700 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4709 if (old_loc
== var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
)
4712 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4716 pool_free (loc_chain_pool
, loc
);
4719 if (!var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
)
4725 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
4731 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4735 dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs (void **slot
, void *data
)
4737 dataflow_set
*set
= (dataflow_set
*) data
;
4738 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
4740 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
4742 location_chain loc
, *locp
;
4743 bool changed
= false;
4746 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4748 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
4750 for (loc
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
4751 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) == MEM
4752 && mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4758 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
4759 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
4760 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4763 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
4764 cur_loc
= VAR_LOC_FROM (var
);
4766 cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
4768 for (locp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, loc
= *locp
;
4771 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) != MEM
4772 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4779 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
4780 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
4781 of changed variables. */
4782 if (cur_loc
== loc
->loc
)
4785 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4786 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
4787 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
4789 pool_free (loc_chain_pool
, loc
);
4792 if (!var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
)
4798 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
4804 /* Remove all variable-location information about call-clobbered
4805 registers, as well as associations between MEMs and VALUEs. */
4808 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (dataflow_set
*set
)
4811 hard_reg_set_iterator hrsi
;
4813 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_HARD_REG_SET (regs_invalidated_by_call
, 0, r
, hrsi
)
4814 var_regno_delete (set
, r
);
4816 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
4818 set
->traversed_vars
= set
->vars
;
4819 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
),
4820 dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs
, set
);
4821 set
->traversed_vars
= set
->vars
;
4822 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
), dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs
,
4824 set
->traversed_vars
= NULL
;
4829 variable_part_different_p (variable_part
*vp1
, variable_part
*vp2
)
4831 location_chain lc1
, lc2
;
4833 for (lc1
= vp1
->loc_chain
; lc1
; lc1
= lc1
->next
)
4835 for (lc2
= vp2
->loc_chain
; lc2
; lc2
= lc2
->next
)
4837 if (REG_P (lc1
->loc
) && REG_P (lc2
->loc
))
4839 if (REGNO (lc1
->loc
) == REGNO (lc2
->loc
))
4842 if (rtx_equal_p (lc1
->loc
, lc2
->loc
))
4851 /* Return true if one-part variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different.
4852 They must be in canonical order. */
4855 onepart_variable_different_p (variable var1
, variable var2
)
4857 location_chain lc1
, lc2
;
4862 gcc_assert (var1
->n_var_parts
== 1
4863 && var2
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4865 lc1
= var1
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4866 lc2
= var2
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4868 gcc_assert (lc1
&& lc2
);
4872 if (loc_cmp (lc1
->loc
, lc2
->loc
))
4881 /* Return true if variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different. */
4884 variable_different_p (variable var1
, variable var2
)
4891 if (var1
->onepart
!= var2
->onepart
)
4894 if (var1
->n_var_parts
!= var2
->n_var_parts
)
4897 if (var1
->onepart
&& var1
->n_var_parts
)
4899 gcc_checking_assert (dv_as_opaque (var1
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var2
->dv
)
4900 && var1
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4901 /* One-part values have locations in a canonical order. */
4902 return onepart_variable_different_p (var1
, var2
);
4905 for (i
= 0; i
< var1
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
4907 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var1
, i
) != VAR_PART_OFFSET (var2
, i
))
4909 if (variable_part_different_p (&var1
->var_part
[i
], &var2
->var_part
[i
]))
4911 if (variable_part_different_p (&var2
->var_part
[i
], &var1
->var_part
[i
]))
4917 /* Return true if dataflow sets OLD_SET and NEW_SET differ. */
4920 dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set
*old_set
, dataflow_set
*new_set
)
4925 if (old_set
->vars
== new_set
->vars
)
4928 if (htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
))
4929 != htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
)))
4932 FOR_EACH_HTAB_ELEMENT (shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
), var1
, variable
, hi
)
4934 htab_t htab
= shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
);
4935 variable var2
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (htab
, var1
->dv
,
4936 dv_htab_hash (var1
->dv
));
4939 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
4941 fprintf (dump_file
, "dataflow difference found: removal of:\n");
4947 if (variable_different_p (var1
, var2
))
4949 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
4951 fprintf (dump_file
, "dataflow difference found: "
4952 "old and new follow:\n");
4960 /* No need to traverse the second hashtab, if both have the same number
4961 of elements and the second one had all entries found in the first one,
4962 then it can't have any extra entries. */
4966 /* Free the contents of dataflow set SET. */
4969 dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set
*set
)
4973 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
4974 attrs_list_clear (&set
->regs
[i
]);
4976 shared_hash_destroy (set
->vars
);
4980 /* Return true if RTL X contains a SYMBOL_REF. */
4983 contains_symbol_ref (rtx x
)
4992 code
= GET_CODE (x
);
4993 if (code
== SYMBOL_REF
)
4996 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
4997 for (i
= GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
5001 if (contains_symbol_ref (XEXP (x
, i
)))
5004 else if (fmt
[i
] == 'E')
5007 for (j
= 0; j
< XVECLEN (x
, i
); j
++)
5008 if (contains_symbol_ref (XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
)))
5016 /* Shall EXPR be tracked? */
5019 track_expr_p (tree expr
, bool need_rtl
)
5024 if (TREE_CODE (expr
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
)
5025 return DECL_RTL_SET_P (expr
);
5027 /* If EXPR is not a parameter or a variable do not track it. */
5028 if (TREE_CODE (expr
) != VAR_DECL
&& TREE_CODE (expr
) != PARM_DECL
)
5031 /* It also must have a name... */
5032 if (!DECL_NAME (expr
) && need_rtl
)
5035 /* ... and a RTL assigned to it. */
5036 decl_rtl
= DECL_RTL_IF_SET (expr
);
5037 if (!decl_rtl
&& need_rtl
)
5040 /* If this expression is really a debug alias of some other declaration, we
5041 don't need to track this expression if the ultimate declaration is
5044 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (realdecl
))
5046 realdecl
= DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (realdecl
);
5047 if (realdecl
== NULL_TREE
)
5049 else if (!DECL_P (realdecl
))
5051 if (handled_component_p (realdecl
)
5052 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl
) == MEM_REF
5053 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl
, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
))
5055 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize
, bitpos
, maxsize
;
5057 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl
, &bitpos
, &bitsize
,
5059 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl
)
5060 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl
)
5061 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl
)
5063 || bitpos
+ bitsize
> 256
5064 || bitsize
!= maxsize
)
5074 /* Do not track EXPR if REALDECL it should be ignored for debugging
5076 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (realdecl
))
5079 /* Do not track global variables until we are able to emit correct location
5081 if (TREE_STATIC (realdecl
))
5084 /* When the EXPR is a DECL for alias of some variable (see example)
5085 the TREE_STATIC flag is not used. Disable tracking all DECLs whose
5086 DECL_RTL contains SYMBOL_REF.
5089 extern char **_dl_argv_internal __attribute__ ((alias ("_dl_argv")));
5092 if (decl_rtl
&& MEM_P (decl_rtl
)
5093 && contains_symbol_ref (XEXP (decl_rtl
, 0)))
5096 /* If RTX is a memory it should not be very large (because it would be
5097 an array or struct). */
5098 if (decl_rtl
&& MEM_P (decl_rtl
))
5100 /* Do not track structures and arrays. */
5101 if (GET_MODE (decl_rtl
) == BLKmode
5102 || AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (realdecl
)))
5104 if (MEM_SIZE_KNOWN_P (decl_rtl
)
5105 && MEM_SIZE (decl_rtl
) > MAX_VAR_PARTS
)
5109 DECL_CHANGED (expr
) = 0;
5110 DECL_CHANGED (realdecl
) = 0;
5114 /* Determine whether a given LOC refers to the same variable part as
5118 same_variable_part_p (rtx loc
, tree expr
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
5121 HOST_WIDE_INT offset2
;
5123 if (! DECL_P (expr
))
5128 expr2
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
5129 offset2
= REG_OFFSET (loc
);
5131 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
5133 expr2
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
5134 offset2
= INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
);
5139 if (! expr2
|| ! DECL_P (expr2
))
5142 expr
= var_debug_decl (expr
);
5143 expr2
= var_debug_decl (expr2
);
5145 return (expr
== expr2
&& offset
== offset2
);
5148 /* LOC is a REG or MEM that we would like to track if possible.
5149 If EXPR is null, we don't know what expression LOC refers to,
5150 otherwise it refers to EXPR + OFFSET. STORE_REG_P is true if
5151 LOC is an lvalue register.
5153 Return true if EXPR is nonnull and if LOC, or some lowpart of it,
5154 is something we can track. When returning true, store the mode of
5155 the lowpart we can track in *MODE_OUT (if nonnull) and its offset
5156 from EXPR in *OFFSET_OUT (if nonnull). */
5159 track_loc_p (rtx loc
, tree expr
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, bool store_reg_p
,
5160 enum machine_mode
*mode_out
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*offset_out
)
5162 enum machine_mode mode
;
5164 if (expr
== NULL
|| !track_expr_p (expr
, true))
5167 /* If REG was a paradoxical subreg, its REG_ATTRS will describe the
5168 whole subreg, but only the old inner part is really relevant. */
5169 mode
= GET_MODE (loc
);
5170 if (REG_P (loc
) && !HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc
)))
5172 enum machine_mode pseudo_mode
;
5174 pseudo_mode
= PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc
));
5175 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
) > GET_MODE_SIZE (pseudo_mode
))
5177 offset
+= byte_lowpart_offset (pseudo_mode
, mode
);
5182 /* If LOC is a paradoxical lowpart of EXPR, refer to EXPR itself.
5183 Do the same if we are storing to a register and EXPR occupies
5184 the whole of register LOC; in that case, the whole of EXPR is
5185 being changed. We exclude complex modes from the second case
5186 because the real and imaginary parts are represented as separate
5187 pseudo registers, even if the whole complex value fits into one
5189 if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
) > GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (expr
))
5191 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (DECL_MODE (expr
))
5192 && hard_regno_nregs
[REGNO (loc
)][DECL_MODE (expr
)] == 1))
5193 && offset
+ byte_lowpart_offset (DECL_MODE (expr
), mode
) == 0)
5195 mode
= DECL_MODE (expr
);
5199 if (offset
< 0 || offset
>= MAX_VAR_PARTS
)
5205 *offset_out
= offset
;
5209 /* Return the MODE lowpart of LOC, or null if LOC is not something we
5210 want to track. When returning nonnull, make sure that the attributes
5211 on the returned value are updated. */
5214 var_lowpart (enum machine_mode mode
, rtx loc
)
5216 unsigned int offset
, reg_offset
, regno
;
5218 if (GET_MODE (loc
) == mode
)
5221 if (!REG_P (loc
) && !MEM_P (loc
))
5224 offset
= byte_lowpart_offset (mode
, GET_MODE (loc
));
5227 return adjust_address_nv (loc
, mode
, offset
);
5229 reg_offset
= subreg_lowpart_offset (mode
, GET_MODE (loc
));
5230 regno
= REGNO (loc
) + subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (loc
), GET_MODE (loc
),
5232 return gen_rtx_REG_offset (loc
, mode
, regno
, offset
);
5235 /* Carry information about uses and stores while walking rtx. */
5237 struct count_use_info
5239 /* The insn where the RTX is. */
5242 /* The basic block where insn is. */
5245 /* The array of n_sets sets in the insn, as determined by cselib. */
5246 struct cselib_set
*sets
;
5249 /* True if we're counting stores, false otherwise. */
5253 /* Find a VALUE corresponding to X. */
5255 static inline cselib_val
*
5256 find_use_val (rtx x
, enum machine_mode mode
, struct count_use_info
*cui
)
5262 /* This is called after uses are set up and before stores are
5263 processed by cselib, so it's safe to look up srcs, but not
5264 dsts. So we look up expressions that appear in srcs or in
5265 dest expressions, but we search the sets array for dests of
5269 /* Some targets represent memset and memcpy patterns
5270 by (set (mem:BLK ...) (reg:[QHSD]I ...)) or
5271 (set (mem:BLK ...) (const_int ...)) or
5272 (set (mem:BLK ...) (mem:BLK ...)). Don't return anything
5273 in that case, otherwise we end up with mode mismatches. */
5274 if (mode
== BLKmode
&& MEM_P (x
))
5276 for (i
= 0; i
< cui
->n_sets
; i
++)
5277 if (cui
->sets
[i
].dest
== x
)
5278 return cui
->sets
[i
].src_elt
;
5281 return cselib_lookup (x
, mode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
5287 /* Replace all registers and addresses in an expression with VALUE
5288 expressions that map back to them, unless the expression is a
5289 register. If no mapping is or can be performed, returns NULL. */
5292 replace_expr_with_values (rtx loc
)
5294 if (REG_P (loc
) || GET_CODE (loc
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
5296 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
5298 cselib_val
*addr
= cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc
, 0),
5299 get_address_mode (loc
), 0,
5302 return replace_equiv_address_nv (loc
, addr
->val_rtx
);
5307 return cselib_subst_to_values (loc
, VOIDmode
);
5310 /* Return true if *X is a DEBUG_EXPR. Usable as an argument to
5311 for_each_rtx to tell whether there are any DEBUG_EXPRs within
5315 rtx_debug_expr_p (rtx
*x
, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
5319 return GET_CODE (loc
) == DEBUG_EXPR
;
5322 /* Determine what kind of micro operation to choose for a USE. Return
5323 MO_CLOBBER if no micro operation is to be generated. */
5325 static enum micro_operation_type
5326 use_type (rtx loc
, struct count_use_info
*cui
, enum machine_mode
*modep
)
5330 if (cui
&& cui
->sets
)
5332 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == VAR_LOCATION
)
5334 if (track_expr_p (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc
), false))
5336 rtx ploc
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc
);
5337 if (! VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (ploc
))
5339 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (ploc
, GET_MODE (loc
), 1,
5342 /* ??? flag_float_store and volatile mems are never
5343 given values, but we could in theory use them for
5345 gcc_assert (val
|| 1);
5353 if (REG_P (loc
) || MEM_P (loc
))
5356 *modep
= GET_MODE (loc
);
5360 || (find_use_val (loc
, GET_MODE (loc
), cui
)
5361 && cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc
, 0),
5362 get_address_mode (loc
), 0,
5368 cselib_val
*val
= find_use_val (loc
, GET_MODE (loc
), cui
);
5370 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5378 gcc_assert (REGNO (loc
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
);
5380 if (loc
== cfa_base_rtx
)
5382 expr
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
5385 return MO_USE_NO_VAR
;
5386 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr
)))
5388 else if (track_loc_p (loc
, expr
, REG_OFFSET (loc
),
5389 false, modep
, NULL
))
5392 return MO_USE_NO_VAR
;
5394 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
5396 expr
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
5400 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr
)))
5402 else if (track_loc_p (loc
, expr
, INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
),
5404 /* Multi-part variables shouldn't refer to one-part
5405 variable names such as VALUEs (never happens) or
5406 DEBUG_EXPRs (only happens in the presence of debug
5408 && (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
5409 || !for_each_rtx (&XEXP (loc
, 0), rtx_debug_expr_p
, NULL
)))
5418 /* Log to OUT information about micro-operation MOPT involving X in
5422 log_op_type (rtx x
, basic_block bb
, rtx insn
,
5423 enum micro_operation_type mopt
, FILE *out
)
5425 fprintf (out
, "bb %i op %i insn %i %s ",
5426 bb
->index
, VTI (bb
)->mos
.length (),
5427 INSN_UID (insn
), micro_operation_type_name
[mopt
]);
5428 print_inline_rtx (out
, x
, 2);
5432 /* Tell whether the CONCAT used to holds a VALUE and its location
5433 needs value resolution, i.e., an attempt of mapping the location
5434 back to other incoming values. */
5435 #define VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION(x) \
5436 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION", (x), CONCAT)->volatil)
5437 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT is a tracked expression, that
5438 should also be handled like a MO_USE. */
5439 #define VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR(x) \
5440 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR", (x), CONCAT)->used)
5441 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a MO_COPY
5443 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED(x) \
5444 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED", (x), CONCAT)->jump)
5445 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a
5446 MO_CLOBBER as well. */
5447 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED(x) \
5448 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED", (x), CONCAT)->unchanging)
5450 /* All preserved VALUEs. */
5451 static vec
<rtx
> preserved_values
;
5453 /* Ensure VAL is preserved and remember it in a vector for vt_emit_notes. */
5456 preserve_value (cselib_val
*val
)
5458 cselib_preserve_value (val
);
5459 preserved_values
.safe_push (val
->val_rtx
);
5462 /* Helper function for MO_VAL_LOC handling. Return non-zero if
5463 any rtxes not suitable for CONST use not replaced by VALUEs
5467 non_suitable_const (rtx
*x
, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
5472 switch (GET_CODE (*x
))
5483 return !MEM_READONLY_P (*x
);
5489 /* Add uses (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5490 to VTI (bb)->mos. INSN is instruction which the LOC is part of. */
5493 add_uses (rtx
*ploc
, void *data
)
5496 enum machine_mode mode
= VOIDmode
;
5497 struct count_use_info
*cui
= (struct count_use_info
*)data
;
5498 enum micro_operation_type type
= use_type (loc
, cui
, &mode
);
5500 if (type
!= MO_CLOBBER
)
5502 basic_block bb
= cui
->bb
;
5506 mo
.u
.loc
= type
== MO_USE
? var_lowpart (mode
, loc
) : loc
;
5507 mo
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
5509 if (type
== MO_VAL_LOC
)
5512 rtx vloc
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc
);
5515 gcc_assert (cui
->sets
);
5518 && !REG_P (XEXP (vloc
, 0))
5519 && !MEM_P (XEXP (vloc
, 0)))
5522 enum machine_mode address_mode
= get_address_mode (mloc
);
5524 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc
, 0), address_mode
, 0,
5527 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5528 preserve_value (val
);
5531 if (CONSTANT_P (vloc
)
5532 && (GET_CODE (vloc
) != CONST
5533 || for_each_rtx (&vloc
, non_suitable_const
, NULL
)))
5534 /* For constants don't look up any value. */;
5535 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc
) && !unsuitable_loc (vloc
)
5536 && (val
= find_use_val (vloc
, GET_MODE (oloc
), cui
)))
5538 enum machine_mode mode2
;
5539 enum micro_operation_type type2
;
5541 bool resolvable
= REG_P (vloc
) || MEM_P (vloc
);
5544 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (vloc
);
5548 oloc
= shallow_copy_rtx (oloc
);
5549 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc
) = nloc
;
5552 oloc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, val
->val_rtx
, oloc
);
5554 type2
= use_type (vloc
, 0, &mode2
);
5556 gcc_assert (type2
== MO_USE
|| type2
== MO_USE_NO_VAR
5557 || type2
== MO_CLOBBER
);
5559 if (type2
== MO_CLOBBER
5560 && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5562 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (oloc
) = resolvable
;
5563 preserve_value (val
);
5566 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc
))
5568 oloc
= shallow_copy_rtx (oloc
);
5569 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc
) = gen_rtx_UNKNOWN_VAR_LOC ();
5574 else if (type
== MO_VAL_USE
)
5576 enum machine_mode mode2
= VOIDmode
;
5577 enum micro_operation_type type2
;
5578 cselib_val
*val
= find_use_val (loc
, GET_MODE (loc
), cui
);
5579 rtx vloc
, oloc
= loc
, nloc
;
5581 gcc_assert (cui
->sets
);
5584 && !REG_P (XEXP (oloc
, 0))
5585 && !MEM_P (XEXP (oloc
, 0)))
5588 enum machine_mode address_mode
= get_address_mode (mloc
);
5590 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc
, 0), address_mode
, 0,
5593 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5594 preserve_value (val
);
5597 type2
= use_type (loc
, 0, &mode2
);
5599 gcc_assert (type2
== MO_USE
|| type2
== MO_USE_NO_VAR
5600 || type2
== MO_CLOBBER
);
5602 if (type2
== MO_USE
)
5603 vloc
= var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
);
5607 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_USE may have two forms:
5609 (concat val src): val is at src, a value-based
5612 (concat (concat val use) src): same as above, with use as
5613 the MO_USE tracked value, if it differs from src.
5617 gcc_checking_assert (REG_P (loc
) || MEM_P (loc
));
5618 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (loc
);
5623 oloc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode2
, val
->val_rtx
, vloc
);
5625 oloc
= val
->val_rtx
;
5627 mo
.u
.loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, oloc
, nloc
);
5629 if (type2
== MO_USE
)
5630 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (mo
.u
.loc
) = 1;
5631 if (!cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5633 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (mo
.u
.loc
) = 1;
5634 preserve_value (val
);
5638 gcc_assert (type
== MO_USE
|| type
== MO_USE_NO_VAR
);
5640 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
5641 log_op_type (mo
.u
.loc
, cui
->bb
, cui
->insn
, mo
.type
, dump_file
);
5642 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
5648 /* Helper function for finding all uses of REG/MEM in X in insn INSN. */
5651 add_uses_1 (rtx
*x
, void *cui
)
5653 for_each_rtx (x
, add_uses
, cui
);
5656 /* This is the value used during expansion of locations. We want it
5657 to be unbounded, so that variables expanded deep in a recursion
5658 nest are fully evaluated, so that their values are cached
5659 correctly. We avoid recursion cycles through other means, and we
5660 don't unshare RTL, so excess complexity is not a problem. */
5661 #define EXPR_DEPTH (INT_MAX)
5662 /* We use this to keep too-complex expressions from being emitted as
5663 location notes, and then to debug information. Users can trade
5664 compile time for ridiculously complex expressions, although they're
5665 seldom useful, and they may often have to be discarded as not
5666 representable anyway. */
5667 #define EXPR_USE_DEPTH (PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_EXPR_DEPTH))
5669 /* Attempt to reverse the EXPR operation in the debug info and record
5670 it in the cselib table. Say for reg1 = reg2 + 6 even when reg2 is
5671 no longer live we can express its value as VAL - 6. */
5674 reverse_op (rtx val
, const_rtx expr
, rtx insn
)
5678 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
5682 if (GET_CODE (expr
) != SET
)
5685 if (!REG_P (SET_DEST (expr
)) || GET_MODE (val
) != GET_MODE (SET_DEST (expr
)))
5688 src
= SET_SRC (expr
);
5689 switch (GET_CODE (src
))
5696 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0)))
5701 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0)) && !MEM_P (XEXP (src
, 0)))
5708 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (src
)) || XEXP (src
, 0) == cfa_base_rtx
)
5711 v
= cselib_lookup (XEXP (src
, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (src
, 0)), 0, VOIDmode
);
5712 if (!v
|| !cselib_preserved_value_p (v
))
5715 /* Use canonical V to avoid creating multiple redundant expressions
5716 for different VALUES equivalent to V. */
5717 v
= canonical_cselib_val (v
);
5719 /* Adding a reverse op isn't useful if V already has an always valid
5720 location. Ignore ENTRY_VALUE, while it is always constant, we should
5721 prefer non-ENTRY_VALUE locations whenever possible. */
5722 for (l
= v
->locs
, count
= 0; l
; l
= l
->next
, count
++)
5723 if (CONSTANT_P (l
->loc
)
5724 && (GET_CODE (l
->loc
) != CONST
|| !references_value_p (l
->loc
, 0)))
5726 /* Avoid creating too large locs lists. */
5727 else if (count
== PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_REVERSE_OP_SIZE
))
5730 switch (GET_CODE (src
))
5734 if (GET_MODE (v
->val_rtx
) != GET_MODE (val
))
5736 ret
= gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (src
), GET_MODE (val
), val
);
5740 ret
= gen_lowpart_SUBREG (GET_MODE (v
->val_rtx
), val
);
5752 if (GET_MODE (v
->val_rtx
) != GET_MODE (val
))
5754 arg
= XEXP (src
, 1);
5755 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg
) && GET_CODE (arg
) != SYMBOL_REF
)
5757 arg
= cselib_expand_value_rtx (arg
, scratch_regs
, 5);
5758 if (arg
== NULL_RTX
)
5760 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg
) && GET_CODE (arg
) != SYMBOL_REF
)
5763 ret
= simplify_gen_binary (code
, GET_MODE (val
), val
, arg
);
5765 /* Ensure ret isn't VALUE itself (which can happen e.g. for
5766 (plus (reg1) (reg2)) when reg2 is known to be 0), as that
5767 breaks a lot of routines during var-tracking. */
5768 ret
= gen_rtx_fmt_ee (PLUS
, GET_MODE (val
), val
, const0_rtx
);
5774 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (v
, ret
, insn
);
5777 /* Add stores (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5778 to VTI (bb)->mos. EXPR is the RTL expression containing the store.
5779 CUIP->insn is instruction which the LOC is part of. */
5782 add_stores (rtx loc
, const_rtx expr
, void *cuip
)
5784 enum machine_mode mode
= VOIDmode
, mode2
;
5785 struct count_use_info
*cui
= (struct count_use_info
*)cuip
;
5786 basic_block bb
= cui
->bb
;
5788 rtx oloc
= loc
, nloc
, src
= NULL
;
5789 enum micro_operation_type type
= use_type (loc
, cui
, &mode
);
5790 bool track_p
= false;
5792 bool resolve
, preserve
;
5794 if (type
== MO_CLOBBER
)
5801 gcc_assert (loc
!= cfa_base_rtx
);
5802 if ((GET_CODE (expr
) == CLOBBER
&& type
!= MO_VAL_SET
)
5803 || !(track_p
= use_type (loc
, NULL
, &mode2
) == MO_USE
)
5804 || GET_CODE (expr
) == CLOBBER
)
5806 mo
.type
= MO_CLOBBER
;
5808 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == SET
5809 && SET_DEST (expr
) == loc
5810 && !unsuitable_loc (SET_SRC (expr
))
5811 && find_use_val (loc
, mode
, cui
))
5813 gcc_checking_assert (type
== MO_VAL_SET
);
5814 mo
.u
.loc
= gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
, loc
, SET_SRC (expr
));
5819 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == SET
5820 && SET_DEST (expr
) == loc
5821 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr
)) != ASM_OPERANDS
)
5822 src
= var_lowpart (mode2
, SET_SRC (expr
));
5823 loc
= var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
);
5832 rtx xexpr
= gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
, loc
, src
);
5833 if (same_variable_part_p (src
, REG_EXPR (loc
), REG_OFFSET (loc
)))
5840 mo
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
5842 else if (MEM_P (loc
)
5843 && ((track_p
= use_type (loc
, NULL
, &mode2
) == MO_USE
)
5846 if (MEM_P (loc
) && type
== MO_VAL_SET
5847 && !REG_P (XEXP (loc
, 0))
5848 && !MEM_P (XEXP (loc
, 0)))
5851 enum machine_mode address_mode
= get_address_mode (mloc
);
5852 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc
, 0),
5856 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5857 preserve_value (val
);
5860 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == CLOBBER
|| !track_p
)
5862 mo
.type
= MO_CLOBBER
;
5863 mo
.u
.loc
= track_p
? var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
) : loc
;
5867 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == SET
5868 && SET_DEST (expr
) == loc
5869 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr
)) != ASM_OPERANDS
)
5870 src
= var_lowpart (mode2
, SET_SRC (expr
));
5871 loc
= var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
);
5880 rtx xexpr
= gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode
, loc
, src
);
5881 if (same_variable_part_p (SET_SRC (xexpr
),
5883 INT_MEM_OFFSET (loc
)))
5890 mo
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
5895 if (type
!= MO_VAL_SET
)
5896 goto log_and_return
;
5898 v
= find_use_val (oloc
, mode
, cui
);
5901 goto log_and_return
;
5903 resolve
= preserve
= !cselib_preserved_value_p (v
);
5905 if (loc
== stack_pointer_rtx
5906 && hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
!= -1
5908 cselib_set_value_sp_based (v
);
5910 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (oloc
);
5914 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui
->insn
)) == COND_EXEC
)
5916 cselib_val
*oval
= cselib_lookup (oloc
, GET_MODE (oloc
), 0, VOIDmode
);
5918 gcc_assert (oval
!= v
);
5919 gcc_assert (REG_P (oloc
) || MEM_P (oloc
));
5921 if (oval
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (oval
))
5923 micro_operation moa
;
5925 preserve_value (oval
);
5927 moa
.type
= MO_VAL_USE
;
5928 moa
.u
.loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, oval
->val_rtx
, oloc
);
5929 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (moa
.u
.loc
) = 1;
5930 moa
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
5932 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
5933 log_op_type (moa
.u
.loc
, cui
->bb
, cui
->insn
,
5934 moa
.type
, dump_file
);
5935 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (moa
);
5940 else if (resolve
&& GET_CODE (mo
.u
.loc
) == SET
)
5942 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (expr
)) || MEM_P (SET_SRC (expr
)))
5943 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (SET_SRC (expr
));
5947 /* Avoid the mode mismatch between oexpr and expr. */
5948 if (!nloc
&& mode
!= mode2
)
5950 nloc
= SET_SRC (expr
);
5951 gcc_assert (oloc
== SET_DEST (expr
));
5954 if (nloc
&& nloc
!= SET_SRC (mo
.u
.loc
))
5955 oloc
= gen_rtx_SET (GET_MODE (mo
.u
.loc
), oloc
, nloc
);
5958 if (oloc
== SET_DEST (mo
.u
.loc
))
5959 /* No point in duplicating. */
5961 if (!REG_P (SET_SRC (mo
.u
.loc
)))
5967 if (GET_CODE (mo
.u
.loc
) == SET
5968 && oloc
== SET_DEST (mo
.u
.loc
))
5969 /* No point in duplicating. */
5975 loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, v
->val_rtx
, oloc
);
5977 if (mo
.u
.loc
!= oloc
)
5978 loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (mo
.u
.loc
), loc
, mo
.u
.loc
);
5980 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_SET may have various forms:
5982 (concat val dst): dst now holds val
5984 (concat val (set dst src)): dst now holds val, copied from src
5986 (concat (concat val dstv) dst): dst now holds val; dstv is dst
5987 after replacing mems and non-top-level regs with values.
5989 (concat (concat val dstv) (set dst src)): dst now holds val,
5990 copied from src. dstv is a value-based representation of dst, if
5991 it differs from dst. If resolution is needed, src is a REG, and
5992 its mode is the same as that of val.
5994 (concat (concat val (set dstv srcv)) (set dst src)): src
5995 copied to dst, holding val. dstv and srcv are value-based
5996 representations of dst and src, respectively.
6000 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui
->insn
)) != COND_EXEC
)
6001 reverse_op (v
->val_rtx
, expr
, cui
->insn
);
6006 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
) = 1;
6009 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
) = resolve
;
6012 if (mo
.type
== MO_CLOBBER
)
6013 VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc
) = 1;
6014 if (mo
.type
== MO_COPY
)
6015 VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc
) = 1;
6017 mo
.type
= MO_VAL_SET
;
6020 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6021 log_op_type (mo
.u
.loc
, cui
->bb
, cui
->insn
, mo
.type
, dump_file
);
6022 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
6025 /* Arguments to the call. */
6026 static rtx call_arguments
;
6028 /* Compute call_arguments. */
6031 prepare_call_arguments (basic_block bb
, rtx insn
)
6034 rtx prev
, cur
, next
;
6035 rtx this_arg
= NULL_RTX
;
6036 tree type
= NULL_TREE
, t
, fndecl
= NULL_TREE
;
6037 tree obj_type_ref
= NULL_TREE
;
6038 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v
;
6039 cumulative_args_t args_so_far
;
6041 memset (&args_so_far_v
, 0, sizeof (args_so_far_v
));
6042 args_so_far
= pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v
);
6043 call
= get_call_rtx_from (insn
);
6046 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (call
, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
)
6048 rtx symbol
= XEXP (XEXP (call
, 0), 0);
6049 if (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol
))
6050 fndecl
= SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol
);
6052 if (fndecl
== NULL_TREE
)
6053 fndecl
= MEM_EXPR (XEXP (call
, 0));
6055 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl
)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
6056 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl
)) != METHOD_TYPE
)
6058 if (fndecl
&& TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fndecl
)))
6059 type
= TREE_TYPE (fndecl
);
6060 if (fndecl
&& TREE_CODE (fndecl
) != FUNCTION_DECL
)
6062 if (TREE_CODE (fndecl
) == INDIRECT_REF
6063 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (fndecl
, 0)) == OBJ_TYPE_REF
)
6064 obj_type_ref
= TREE_OPERAND (fndecl
, 0);
6069 for (t
= TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
); t
&& t
!= void_list_node
;
6071 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (t
)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
6072 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (t
))))
6074 if ((t
== NULL
|| t
== void_list_node
) && obj_type_ref
== NULL_TREE
)
6078 int nargs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
= list_length (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
));
6079 link
= CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn
);
6080 #ifndef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
6081 if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (type
), type
)
6082 && targetm
.calls
.struct_value_rtx (type
, 0) == 0)
6084 tree struct_addr
= build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (type
));
6085 enum machine_mode mode
= TYPE_MODE (struct_addr
);
6087 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v
, type
, NULL_RTX
, fndecl
,
6089 reg
= targetm
.calls
.function_arg (args_so_far
, mode
,
6091 targetm
.calls
.function_arg_advance (args_so_far
, mode
,
6093 if (reg
== NULL_RTX
)
6095 for (; link
; link
= XEXP (link
, 1))
6096 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link
, 0)) == USE
6097 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0)))
6099 link
= XEXP (link
, 1);
6106 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v
, type
, NULL_RTX
, fndecl
,
6108 if (obj_type_ref
&& TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
) != void_list_node
)
6110 enum machine_mode mode
;
6111 t
= TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
);
6112 mode
= TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (t
));
6113 this_arg
= targetm
.calls
.function_arg (args_so_far
, mode
,
6114 TREE_VALUE (t
), true);
6115 if (this_arg
&& !REG_P (this_arg
))
6116 this_arg
= NULL_RTX
;
6117 else if (this_arg
== NULL_RTX
)
6119 for (; link
; link
= XEXP (link
, 1))
6120 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link
, 0)) == USE
6121 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0)))
6123 this_arg
= XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0);
6131 t
= type
? TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
) : NULL_TREE
;
6133 for (link
= CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn
); link
; link
= XEXP (link
, 1))
6134 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link
, 0)) == USE
)
6136 rtx item
= NULL_RTX
;
6137 x
= XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0);
6138 if (GET_MODE (link
) == VOIDmode
6139 || GET_MODE (link
) == BLKmode
6140 || (GET_MODE (link
) != GET_MODE (x
)
6141 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (link
)) != MODE_INT
6142 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x
)) != MODE_INT
)))
6143 /* Can't do anything for these, if the original type mode
6144 isn't known or can't be converted. */;
6147 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (x
, GET_MODE (x
), 0, VOIDmode
);
6148 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6149 item
= val
->val_rtx
;
6150 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x
)) == MODE_INT
)
6152 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (x
);
6154 while ((mode
= GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode
)) != VOIDmode
6155 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode
) <= BITS_PER_WORD
)
6157 rtx reg
= simplify_subreg (mode
, x
, GET_MODE (x
), 0);
6159 if (reg
== NULL_RTX
|| !REG_P (reg
))
6161 val
= cselib_lookup (reg
, mode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
6162 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6164 item
= val
->val_rtx
;
6175 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
6177 struct adjust_mem_data amd
;
6178 amd
.mem_mode
= VOIDmode
;
6179 amd
.stack_adjust
= -VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
6180 amd
.side_effects
= NULL_RTX
;
6182 mem
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem
, NULL_RTX
, adjust_mems
,
6184 gcc_assert (amd
.side_effects
== NULL_RTX
);
6186 val
= cselib_lookup (mem
, GET_MODE (mem
), 0, VOIDmode
);
6187 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6188 item
= val
->val_rtx
;
6189 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (mem
)) != MODE_INT
)
6191 /* For non-integer stack argument see also if they weren't
6192 initialized by integers. */
6193 enum machine_mode imode
= int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (mem
));
6194 if (imode
!= GET_MODE (mem
) && imode
!= BLKmode
)
6196 val
= cselib_lookup (adjust_address_nv (mem
, imode
, 0),
6197 imode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
6198 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6199 item
= lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (x
), val
->val_rtx
,
6207 if (GET_MODE (item
) != GET_MODE (link
))
6208 item
= lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link
), item
, GET_MODE (item
));
6209 if (GET_MODE (x2
) != GET_MODE (link
))
6210 x2
= lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link
), x2
, GET_MODE (x2
));
6211 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (link
), x2
, item
);
6213 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
, call_arguments
);
6215 if (t
&& t
!= void_list_node
)
6217 tree argtype
= TREE_VALUE (t
);
6218 enum machine_mode mode
= TYPE_MODE (argtype
);
6220 if (pass_by_reference (&args_so_far_v
, mode
, argtype
, true))
6222 argtype
= build_pointer_type (argtype
);
6223 mode
= TYPE_MODE (argtype
);
6225 reg
= targetm
.calls
.function_arg (args_so_far
, mode
,
6227 if (TREE_CODE (argtype
) == REFERENCE_TYPE
6228 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (argtype
))
6231 && GET_MODE (reg
) == mode
6232 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode
) == MODE_INT
6234 && REGNO (x
) == REGNO (reg
)
6235 && GET_MODE (x
) == mode
6238 enum machine_mode indmode
6239 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (argtype
));
6240 rtx mem
= gen_rtx_MEM (indmode
, x
);
6241 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (mem
, indmode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
6242 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6244 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode
, mem
, val
->val_rtx
);
6245 call_arguments
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
,
6250 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
6253 /* Try harder, when passing address of a constant
6254 pool integer it can be easily read back. */
6255 item
= XEXP (item
, 1);
6256 if (GET_CODE (item
) == SUBREG
)
6257 item
= SUBREG_REG (item
);
6258 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (item
) == VALUE
);
6259 val
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (item
);
6260 for (l
= val
->locs
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
6261 if (GET_CODE (l
->loc
) == SYMBOL_REF
6262 && TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (l
->loc
)
6263 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l
->loc
)
6264 && DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l
->loc
)))
6266 initial
= DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l
->loc
));
6267 if (host_integerp (initial
, 0))
6269 item
= GEN_INT (tree_low_cst (initial
, 0));
6270 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode
, mem
, item
);
6272 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
,
6279 targetm
.calls
.function_arg_advance (args_so_far
, mode
,
6285 /* Add debug arguments. */
6287 && TREE_CODE (fndecl
) == FUNCTION_DECL
6288 && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_ARGS_P (fndecl
))
6290 vec
<tree
, va_gc
> **debug_args
= decl_debug_args_lookup (fndecl
);
6295 for (ix
= 0; vec_safe_iterate (*debug_args
, ix
, ¶m
); ix
+= 2)
6298 tree dtemp
= (**debug_args
)[ix
+ 1];
6299 enum machine_mode mode
= DECL_MODE (dtemp
);
6300 item
= gen_rtx_DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF (mode
, param
);
6301 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, item
, DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dtemp
));
6302 call_arguments
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
,
6308 /* Reverse call_arguments chain. */
6310 for (cur
= call_arguments
; cur
; cur
= next
)
6312 next
= XEXP (cur
, 1);
6313 XEXP (cur
, 1) = prev
;
6316 call_arguments
= prev
;
6318 x
= get_call_rtx_from (insn
);
6321 x
= XEXP (XEXP (x
, 0), 0);
6322 if (GET_CODE (x
) == SYMBOL_REF
)
6323 /* Don't record anything. */;
6324 else if (CONSTANT_P (x
))
6326 x
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x
) == VOIDmode
? Pmode
: GET_MODE (x
),
6329 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, x
, call_arguments
);
6333 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (x
, GET_MODE (x
), 0, VOIDmode
);
6334 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6336 x
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x
), pc_rtx
, val
->val_rtx
);
6338 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, x
, call_arguments
);
6344 enum machine_mode mode
6345 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (obj_type_ref
)));
6346 rtx clobbered
= gen_rtx_MEM (mode
, this_arg
);
6348 = tree_low_cst (OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (obj_type_ref
), 0);
6350 clobbered
= plus_constant (mode
, clobbered
,
6351 token
* GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
));
6352 clobbered
= gen_rtx_MEM (mode
, clobbered
);
6353 x
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode
, pc_rtx
), clobbered
);
6355 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, x
, call_arguments
);
6359 /* Callback for cselib_record_sets_hook, that records as micro
6360 operations uses and stores in an insn after cselib_record_sets has
6361 analyzed the sets in an insn, but before it modifies the stored
6362 values in the internal tables, unless cselib_record_sets doesn't
6363 call it directly (perhaps because we're not doing cselib in the
6364 first place, in which case sets and n_sets will be 0). */
6367 add_with_sets (rtx insn
, struct cselib_set
*sets
, int n_sets
)
6369 basic_block bb
= BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn
);
6371 struct count_use_info cui
;
6372 micro_operation
*mos
;
6374 cselib_hook_called
= true;
6379 cui
.n_sets
= n_sets
;
6381 n1
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length ();
6382 cui
.store_p
= false;
6383 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn
), add_uses_1
, &cui
);
6384 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6385 mos
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.address ();
6387 /* Order the MO_USEs to be before MO_USE_NO_VARs and MO_VAL_USE, and
6391 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
== MO_USE
)
6393 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
!= MO_USE
)
6405 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6408 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
!= MO_VAL_LOC
)
6410 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
== MO_VAL_LOC
)
6428 mo
.u
.loc
= call_arguments
;
6429 call_arguments
= NULL_RTX
;
6431 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6432 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn
), bb
, insn
, mo
.type
, dump_file
);
6433 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
6436 n1
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length ();
6437 /* This will record NEXT_INSN (insn), such that we can
6438 insert notes before it without worrying about any
6439 notes that MO_USEs might emit after the insn. */
6441 note_stores (PATTERN (insn
), add_stores
, &cui
);
6442 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6443 mos
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.address ();
6445 /* Order the MO_VAL_USEs first (note_stores does nothing
6446 on DEBUG_INSNs, so there are no MO_VAL_LOCs from this
6447 insn), then MO_CLOBBERs, then MO_SET/MO_COPY/MO_VAL_SET. */
6450 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
== MO_VAL_USE
)
6452 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
!= MO_VAL_USE
)
6464 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6467 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
== MO_CLOBBER
)
6469 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
!= MO_CLOBBER
)
6482 static enum var_init_status
6483 find_src_status (dataflow_set
*in
, rtx src
)
6485 tree decl
= NULL_TREE
;
6486 enum var_init_status status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
;
6488 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
6489 status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
6491 if (src
&& REG_P (src
))
6492 decl
= var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src
));
6493 else if (src
&& MEM_P (src
))
6494 decl
= var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src
));
6497 status
= get_init_value (in
, src
, dv_from_decl (decl
));
6502 /* SRC is the source of an assignment. Use SET to try to find what
6503 was ultimately assigned to SRC. Return that value if known,
6504 otherwise return SRC itself. */
6507 find_src_set_src (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx src
)
6509 tree decl
= NULL_TREE
; /* The variable being copied around. */
6510 rtx set_src
= NULL_RTX
; /* The value for "decl" stored in "src". */
6512 location_chain nextp
;
6516 if (src
&& REG_P (src
))
6517 decl
= var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src
));
6518 else if (src
&& MEM_P (src
))
6519 decl
= var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src
));
6523 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_decl (decl
);
6525 var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
);
6529 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
&& !found
; i
++)
6530 for (nextp
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; nextp
&& !found
;
6531 nextp
= nextp
->next
)
6532 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp
->loc
, src
))
6534 set_src
= nextp
->set_src
;
6544 /* Compute the changes of variable locations in the basic block BB. */
6547 compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block bb
)
6550 micro_operation
*mo
;
6552 dataflow_set old_out
;
6553 dataflow_set
*in
= &VTI (bb
)->in
;
6554 dataflow_set
*out
= &VTI (bb
)->out
;
6556 dataflow_set_init (&old_out
);
6557 dataflow_set_copy (&old_out
, out
);
6558 dataflow_set_copy (out
, in
);
6560 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
6561 local_get_addr_cache
= pointer_map_create ();
6563 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (VTI (bb
)->mos
, i
, mo
)
6565 rtx insn
= mo
->insn
;
6570 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (out
);
6575 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6578 var_reg_set (out
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
6579 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
6580 var_mem_set (out
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
6586 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6590 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == CONCAT
)
6592 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
6593 vloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
6601 var
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc
);
6603 clobber_variable_part (out
, NULL_RTX
,
6604 dv_from_decl (var
), 0, NULL_RTX
);
6607 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6608 val_resolve (out
, val
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
), insn
);
6609 set_variable_part (out
, val
, dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
6610 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
6613 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
)))
6614 set_variable_part (out
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
),
6615 dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
6616 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
6623 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6624 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
6626 vloc
= uloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
6627 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
6629 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
6631 uloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
6632 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
6635 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6636 val_resolve (out
, val
, vloc
, insn
);
6638 val_store (out
, val
, uloc
, insn
, false);
6640 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
6642 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == REG
)
6643 var_reg_set (out
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
6645 else if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == MEM
)
6646 var_mem_set (out
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
6654 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6655 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
6659 uloc
= XEXP (vloc
, 1);
6660 val
= XEXP (vloc
, 0);
6663 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
6665 dstv
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
6666 srcv
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
6674 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
6676 dstv
= vloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
6677 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
6680 if (GET_CODE (vloc
) == SET
)
6682 srcv
= SET_SRC (vloc
);
6684 gcc_assert (val
!= srcv
);
6685 gcc_assert (vloc
== uloc
|| VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
));
6687 dstv
= vloc
= SET_DEST (vloc
);
6689 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6690 val_resolve (out
, val
, srcv
, insn
);
6692 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6694 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
6695 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc
)) == REG
);
6696 val_resolve (out
, val
, SET_SRC (uloc
), insn
);
6699 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
6701 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc
))
6704 var_reg_delete (out
, uloc
, true);
6705 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
6707 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
6708 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (uloc
));
6709 var_mem_delete (out
, dstv
, true);
6714 bool copied_p
= VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc
);
6715 rtx src
= NULL
, dst
= uloc
;
6716 enum var_init_status status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
6718 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
6720 src
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
6721 dst
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
6726 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
6728 status
= find_src_status (in
, src
);
6730 if (status
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
6731 status
= find_src_status (out
, src
);
6734 src
= find_src_set_src (in
, src
);
6738 var_reg_delete_and_set (out
, dst
, !copied_p
,
6740 else if (MEM_P (dst
))
6742 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
6743 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (dst
));
6744 var_mem_delete_and_set (out
, dstv
, !copied_p
,
6749 else if (REG_P (uloc
))
6750 var_regno_delete (out
, REGNO (uloc
));
6751 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
6753 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (vloc
) == MEM
);
6754 gcc_checking_assert (dstv
== vloc
);
6756 clobber_overlapping_mems (out
, vloc
);
6759 val_store (out
, val
, dstv
, insn
, true);
6765 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6768 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
6770 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
6771 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
6775 var_reg_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
6777 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
6778 var_mem_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
6785 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6786 enum var_init_status src_status
;
6789 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
6791 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
6792 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
6795 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
6796 src_status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
6799 src_status
= find_src_status (in
, set_src
);
6801 if (src_status
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
6802 src_status
= find_src_status (out
, set_src
);
6805 set_src
= find_src_set_src (in
, set_src
);
6808 var_reg_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
6809 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
6810 var_mem_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
6816 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6819 var_reg_delete (out
, loc
, false);
6820 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
6821 var_mem_delete (out
, loc
, false);
6827 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6830 var_reg_delete (out
, loc
, true);
6831 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
6832 var_mem_delete (out
, loc
, true);
6837 out
->stack_adjust
+= mo
->u
.adjust
;
6842 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
6844 pointer_map_destroy (local_get_addr_cache
);
6845 local_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
6847 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (out
);
6848 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (out
->vars
), canonicalize_values_mark
,
6850 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (out
->vars
), canonicalize_values_star
,
6853 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (out
->vars
),
6854 canonicalize_loc_order_check
, out
);
6857 changed
= dataflow_set_different (&old_out
, out
);
6858 dataflow_set_destroy (&old_out
);
6862 /* Find the locations of variables in the whole function. */
6865 vt_find_locations (void)
6867 fibheap_t worklist
, pending
, fibheap_swap
;
6868 sbitmap visited
, in_worklist
, in_pending
, sbitmap_swap
;
6875 int htabmax
= PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_SIZE
);
6876 bool success
= true;
6878 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW
);
6879 /* Compute reverse completion order of depth first search of the CFG
6880 so that the data-flow runs faster. */
6881 rc_order
= XNEWVEC (int, n_basic_blocks
- NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
);
6882 bb_order
= XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block
);
6883 pre_and_rev_post_order_compute (NULL
, rc_order
, false);
6884 for (i
= 0; i
< n_basic_blocks
- NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
; i
++)
6885 bb_order
[rc_order
[i
]] = i
;
6888 worklist
= fibheap_new ();
6889 pending
= fibheap_new ();
6890 visited
= sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block
);
6891 in_worklist
= sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block
);
6892 in_pending
= sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block
);
6893 bitmap_clear (in_worklist
);
6896 fibheap_insert (pending
, bb_order
[bb
->index
], bb
);
6897 bitmap_ones (in_pending
);
6899 while (success
&& !fibheap_empty (pending
))
6901 fibheap_swap
= pending
;
6903 worklist
= fibheap_swap
;
6904 sbitmap_swap
= in_pending
;
6905 in_pending
= in_worklist
;
6906 in_worklist
= sbitmap_swap
;
6908 bitmap_clear (visited
);
6910 while (!fibheap_empty (worklist
))
6912 bb
= (basic_block
) fibheap_extract_min (worklist
);
6913 bitmap_clear_bit (in_worklist
, bb
->index
);
6914 gcc_assert (!bitmap_bit_p (visited
, bb
->index
));
6915 if (!bitmap_bit_p (visited
, bb
->index
))
6919 int oldinsz
, oldoutsz
;
6921 bitmap_set_bit (visited
, bb
->index
);
6923 if (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
)
6926 -= (htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
))
6927 + htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
)));
6929 = htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
));
6931 = htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
));
6934 oldinsz
= oldoutsz
= 0;
6936 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
6938 dataflow_set
*in
= &VTI (bb
)->in
, *first_out
= NULL
;
6939 bool first
= true, adjust
= false;
6941 /* Calculate the IN set as the intersection of
6942 predecessor OUT sets. */
6944 dataflow_set_clear (in
);
6945 dst_can_be_shared
= true;
6947 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->preds
)
6948 if (!VTI (e
->src
)->flooded
)
6949 gcc_assert (bb_order
[bb
->index
]
6950 <= bb_order
[e
->src
->index
]);
6953 dataflow_set_copy (in
, &VTI (e
->src
)->out
);
6954 first_out
= &VTI (e
->src
)->out
;
6959 dataflow_set_merge (in
, &VTI (e
->src
)->out
);
6965 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (in
, &VTI (bb
)->permp
);
6967 /* Merge and merge_adjust should keep entries in
6969 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (in
->vars
),
6970 canonicalize_loc_order_check
,
6973 if (dst_can_be_shared
)
6975 shared_hash_destroy (in
->vars
);
6976 in
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (first_out
->vars
);
6980 VTI (bb
)->flooded
= true;
6984 /* Calculate the IN set as union of predecessor OUT sets. */
6985 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
6986 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->preds
)
6987 dataflow_set_union (&VTI (bb
)->in
, &VTI (e
->src
)->out
);
6990 changed
= compute_bb_dataflow (bb
);
6991 htabsz
+= (htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
))
6992 + htab_size (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
)));
6994 if (htabmax
&& htabsz
> htabmax
)
6996 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
6997 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun
->decl
),
6998 "variable tracking size limit exceeded with "
6999 "-fvar-tracking-assignments, retrying without");
7001 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun
->decl
),
7002 "variable tracking size limit exceeded");
7009 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->succs
)
7011 if (e
->dest
== EXIT_BLOCK_PTR
)
7014 if (bitmap_bit_p (visited
, e
->dest
->index
))
7016 if (!bitmap_bit_p (in_pending
, e
->dest
->index
))
7018 /* Send E->DEST to next round. */
7019 bitmap_set_bit (in_pending
, e
->dest
->index
);
7020 fibheap_insert (pending
,
7021 bb_order
[e
->dest
->index
],
7025 else if (!bitmap_bit_p (in_worklist
, e
->dest
->index
))
7027 /* Add E->DEST to current round. */
7028 bitmap_set_bit (in_worklist
, e
->dest
->index
);
7029 fibheap_insert (worklist
, bb_order
[e
->dest
->index
],
7037 "BB %i: in %i (was %i), out %i (was %i), rem %i + %i, tsz %i\n",
7039 (int)htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
)),
7041 (int)htab_elements (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
)),
7043 (int)worklist
->nodes
, (int)pending
->nodes
, htabsz
);
7045 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7047 fprintf (dump_file
, "BB %i IN:\n", bb
->index
);
7048 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
7049 fprintf (dump_file
, "BB %i OUT:\n", bb
->index
);
7050 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
7056 if (success
&& MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
7058 gcc_assert (VTI (bb
)->flooded
);
7061 fibheap_delete (worklist
);
7062 fibheap_delete (pending
);
7063 sbitmap_free (visited
);
7064 sbitmap_free (in_worklist
);
7065 sbitmap_free (in_pending
);
7067 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW
);
7071 /* Print the content of the LIST to dump file. */
7074 dump_attrs_list (attrs list
)
7076 for (; list
; list
= list
->next
)
7078 if (dv_is_decl_p (list
->dv
))
7079 print_mem_expr (dump_file
, dv_as_decl (list
->dv
));
7081 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, dv_as_value (list
->dv
));
7082 fprintf (dump_file
, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC
, list
->offset
);
7084 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7087 /* Print the information about variable *SLOT to dump file. */
7090 dump_var_slot (void **slot
, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
7092 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
7096 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
7100 /* Print the information about variable VAR to dump file. */
7103 dump_var (variable var
)
7106 location_chain node
;
7108 if (dv_is_decl_p (var
->dv
))
7110 const_tree decl
= dv_as_decl (var
->dv
);
7112 if (DECL_NAME (decl
))
7114 fprintf (dump_file
, " name: %s",
7115 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl
)));
7116 if (dump_flags
& TDF_UID
)
7117 fprintf (dump_file
, "D.%u", DECL_UID (decl
));
7119 else if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
)
7120 fprintf (dump_file
, " name: D#%u", DEBUG_TEMP_UID (decl
));
7122 fprintf (dump_file
, " name: D.%u", DECL_UID (decl
));
7123 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7127 fputc (' ', dump_file
);
7128 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, dv_as_value (var
->dv
));
7131 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
7133 fprintf (dump_file
, " offset %ld\n",
7134 (long)(var
->onepart
? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
)));
7135 for (node
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
7137 fprintf (dump_file
, " ");
7138 if (node
->init
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
7139 fprintf (dump_file
, "[uninit]");
7140 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, node
->loc
);
7145 /* Print the information about variables from hash table VARS to dump file. */
7148 dump_vars (htab_t vars
)
7150 if (htab_elements (vars
) > 0)
7152 fprintf (dump_file
, "Variables:\n");
7153 htab_traverse (vars
, dump_var_slot
, NULL
);
7157 /* Print the dataflow set SET to dump file. */
7160 dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set
*set
)
7164 fprintf (dump_file
, "Stack adjustment: " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC
"\n",
7166 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
7170 fprintf (dump_file
, "Reg %d:", i
);
7171 dump_attrs_list (set
->regs
[i
]);
7174 dump_vars (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
));
7175 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7178 /* Print the IN and OUT sets for each basic block to dump file. */
7181 dump_dataflow_sets (void)
7187 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nBasic block %d:\n", bb
->index
);
7188 fprintf (dump_file
, "IN:\n");
7189 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
7190 fprintf (dump_file
, "OUT:\n");
7191 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
7195 /* Return the variable for DV in dropped_values, inserting one if
7196 requested with INSERT. */
7198 static inline variable
7199 variable_from_dropped (decl_or_value dv
, enum insert_option insert
)
7203 onepart_enum_t onepart
;
7205 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (dropped_values
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
),
7212 return (variable
) *slot
;
7214 gcc_checking_assert (insert
== INSERT
);
7216 onepart
= dv_onepart_p (dv
);
7218 gcc_checking_assert (onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
|| onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
);
7220 empty_var
= (variable
) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart
));
7222 empty_var
->refcount
= 1;
7223 empty_var
->n_var_parts
= 0;
7224 empty_var
->onepart
= onepart
;
7225 empty_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
7226 empty_var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7227 empty_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7228 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = NULL
;
7229 set_dv_changed (dv
, true);
7236 /* Recover the one-part aux from dropped_values. */
7238 static struct onepart_aux
*
7239 recover_dropped_1paux (variable var
)
7243 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
);
7245 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7246 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
7248 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VDECL
)
7251 dvar
= variable_from_dropped (var
->dv
, NO_INSERT
);
7256 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar
);
7257 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar
) = NULL
;
7259 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
7262 /* Add variable VAR to the hash table of changed variables and
7263 if it has no locations delete it from SET's hash table. */
7266 variable_was_changed (variable var
, dataflow_set
*set
)
7268 hashval_t hash
= dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
);
7274 /* Remember this decl or VALUE has been added to changed_variables. */
7275 set_dv_changed (var
->dv
, true);
7277 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables
,
7283 variable old_var
= (variable
) *slot
;
7284 gcc_assert (old_var
->in_changed_variables
);
7285 old_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
7286 if (var
!= old_var
&& var
->onepart
)
7288 /* Restore the auxiliary info from an empty variable
7289 previously created for changed_variables, so it is
7291 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
));
7292 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
);
7293 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = NULL
;
7295 variable_htab_free (*slot
);
7298 if (set
&& var
->n_var_parts
== 0)
7300 onepart_enum_t onepart
= var
->onepart
;
7301 variable empty_var
= NULL
;
7302 void **dslot
= NULL
;
7304 if (onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
|| onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
7306 dslot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (dropped_values
, var
->dv
,
7307 dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
),
7309 empty_var
= (variable
) *dslot
;
7313 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var
->in_changed_variables
);
7314 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7316 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
);
7317 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = NULL
;
7320 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
));
7326 empty_var
= (variable
) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart
));
7327 empty_var
->dv
= var
->dv
;
7328 empty_var
->refcount
= 1;
7329 empty_var
->n_var_parts
= 0;
7330 empty_var
->onepart
= onepart
;
7333 empty_var
->refcount
++;
7338 empty_var
->refcount
++;
7339 empty_var
->in_changed_variables
= true;
7343 empty_var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7344 empty_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7345 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
7346 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
7352 if (var
->onepart
&& !VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7353 recover_dropped_1paux (var
);
7355 var
->in_changed_variables
= true;
7362 if (var
->n_var_parts
== 0)
7367 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, var
->dv
);
7370 if (shared_hash_shared (set
->vars
))
7371 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, var
->dv
,
7373 htab_clear_slot (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
), slot
);
7379 /* Look for the index in VAR->var_part corresponding to OFFSET.
7380 Return -1 if not found. If INSERTION_POINT is non-NULL, the
7381 referenced int will be set to the index that the part has or should
7382 have, if it should be inserted. */
7385 find_variable_location_part (variable var
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
,
7386 int *insertion_point
)
7395 if (insertion_point
)
7396 *insertion_point
= 0;
7398 return var
->n_var_parts
- 1;
7401 /* Find the location part. */
7403 high
= var
->n_var_parts
;
7406 pos
= (low
+ high
) / 2;
7407 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, pos
) < offset
)
7414 if (insertion_point
)
7415 *insertion_point
= pos
;
7417 if (pos
< var
->n_var_parts
&& VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, pos
) == offset
)
7424 set_slot_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, void **slot
,
7425 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
,
7426 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
)
7429 location_chain node
, next
;
7430 location_chain
*nextp
;
7432 onepart_enum_t onepart
;
7434 var
= (variable
) *slot
;
7437 onepart
= var
->onepart
;
7439 onepart
= dv_onepart_p (dv
);
7441 gcc_checking_assert (offset
== 0 || !onepart
);
7442 gcc_checking_assert (loc
!= dv_as_opaque (dv
));
7444 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
7445 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
7449 /* Create new variable information. */
7450 var
= (variable
) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (onepart
));
7453 var
->n_var_parts
= 1;
7454 var
->onepart
= onepart
;
7455 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
7457 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
7459 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, 0) = offset
;
7460 var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7461 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7464 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
7470 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
));
7474 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
)
7476 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7477 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7478 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
7480 if (node
->loc
== loc
)
7485 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, loc
))
7493 else if (REG_P (node
->loc
) || MEM_P (node
->loc
))
7501 else if (REG_P (loc
))
7503 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7504 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7505 if (REG_P (node
->loc
))
7507 if (REGNO (node
->loc
) < REGNO (loc
))
7511 if (REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7524 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
7526 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7527 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7528 if (REG_P (node
->loc
))
7530 else if (MEM_P (node
->loc
))
7532 if ((r
= loc_cmp (XEXP (node
->loc
, 0), XEXP (loc
, 0))) >= 0)
7544 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7545 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7546 if ((r
= loc_cmp (node
->loc
, loc
)) >= 0)
7554 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
7556 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, initialized
);
7557 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
7558 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; c
;
7559 nextp
= &(*nextp
)->next
)
7561 gcc_assert ((!node
&& !*nextp
) || node
->loc
== (*nextp
)->loc
);
7568 gcc_assert (dv_as_decl (var
->dv
) == dv_as_decl (dv
));
7570 pos
= find_variable_location_part (var
, offset
, &inspos
);
7574 node
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7577 && ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
7578 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7579 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
)))
7581 /* LOC is in the beginning of the chain so we have nothing
7583 if (node
->init
< initialized
)
7584 node
->init
= initialized
;
7585 if (set_src
!= NULL
)
7586 node
->set_src
= set_src
;
7592 /* We have to make a copy of a shared variable. */
7593 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
7595 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, initialized
);
7596 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
7602 /* We have not found the location part, new one will be created. */
7604 /* We have to make a copy of the shared variable. */
7605 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
7607 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, initialized
);
7608 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
7611 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
7612 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
7613 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
< MAX_VAR_PARTS
7614 && (!var
->n_var_parts
|| !onepart
));
7616 /* We have to move the elements of array starting at index
7617 inspos to the next position. */
7618 for (pos
= var
->n_var_parts
; pos
> inspos
; pos
--)
7619 var
->var_part
[pos
] = var
->var_part
[pos
- 1];
7622 gcc_checking_assert (!onepart
);
7623 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, pos
) = offset
;
7624 var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7625 var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7628 /* Delete the location from the list. */
7629 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7630 for (node
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= next
)
7633 if ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
7634 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7635 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
))
7637 /* Save these values, to assign to the new node, before
7638 deleting this one. */
7639 if (node
->init
> initialized
)
7640 initialized
= node
->init
;
7641 if (node
->set_src
!= NULL
&& set_src
== NULL
)
7642 set_src
= node
->set_src
;
7643 if (var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
== node
->loc
)
7644 var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7645 pool_free (loc_chain_pool
, node
);
7650 nextp
= &node
->next
;
7653 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7656 /* Add the location to the beginning. */
7657 node
= (location_chain
) pool_alloc (loc_chain_pool
);
7659 node
->init
= initialized
;
7660 node
->set_src
= set_src
;
7661 node
->next
= *nextp
;
7664 /* If no location was emitted do so. */
7665 if (var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
== NULL
)
7666 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
7671 /* Set the part of variable's location in the dataflow set SET. The
7672 variable part is specified by variable's declaration in DV and
7673 offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. IOPT should be
7674 NO_INSERT if the variable is known to be in SET already and the
7675 variable hash table must not be resized, and INSERT otherwise. */
7678 set_variable_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
,
7679 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
,
7680 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
,
7681 enum insert_option iopt
)
7685 if (iopt
== NO_INSERT
)
7686 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
7689 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot (set
->vars
, dv
);
7691 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, dv
, iopt
);
7693 set_slot_part (set
, loc
, slot
, dv
, offset
, initialized
, set_src
);
7696 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7697 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7698 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7699 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7702 clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, void **slot
,
7703 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
)
7705 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
7706 int pos
= find_variable_location_part (var
, offset
, NULL
);
7710 location_chain node
, next
;
7712 /* Remove the register locations from the dataflow set. */
7713 next
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7714 for (node
= next
; node
; node
= next
)
7717 if (node
->loc
!= loc
7718 && (!flag_var_tracking_uninit
7721 || !rtx_equal_p (set_src
, node
->set_src
)))
7723 if (REG_P (node
->loc
))
7728 /* Remove the variable part from the register's
7729 list, but preserve any other variable parts
7730 that might be regarded as live in that same
7732 anextp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)];
7733 for (anode
= *anextp
; anode
; anode
= anext
)
7735 anext
= anode
->next
;
7736 if (dv_as_opaque (anode
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
)
7737 && anode
->offset
== offset
)
7739 pool_free (attrs_pool
, anode
);
7743 anextp
= &anode
->next
;
7747 slot
= delete_slot_part (set
, node
->loc
, slot
, offset
);
7755 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7756 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7757 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7758 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7761 clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, decl_or_value dv
,
7762 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
)
7766 if (!dv_as_opaque (dv
)
7767 || (!dv_is_value_p (dv
) && ! DECL_P (dv_as_decl (dv
))))
7770 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
7774 clobber_slot_part (set
, loc
, slot
, offset
, set_src
);
7777 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
7778 variable part is specified by its SET->vars slot SLOT and offset
7779 OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
7782 delete_slot_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, void **slot
,
7783 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
7785 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
7786 int pos
= find_variable_location_part (var
, offset
, NULL
);
7790 location_chain node
, next
;
7791 location_chain
*nextp
;
7795 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
7797 /* If the variable contains the location part we have to
7798 make a copy of the variable. */
7799 for (node
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
; node
;
7802 if ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
7803 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7804 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
))
7806 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
,
7807 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
7808 var
= (variable
)*slot
;
7814 if (pos
== 0 && var
->onepart
&& VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7815 cur_loc
= VAR_LOC_FROM (var
);
7817 cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
;
7819 /* Delete the location part. */
7821 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7822 for (node
= *nextp
; node
; node
= next
)
7825 if ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
7826 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7827 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
))
7829 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
7830 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
7831 of changed variables. */
7832 if (cur_loc
== node
->loc
)
7835 var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7836 if (pos
== 0 && var
->onepart
&& VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7837 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
7839 pool_free (loc_chain_pool
, node
);
7844 nextp
= &node
->next
;
7847 if (var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
== NULL
)
7851 while (pos
< var
->n_var_parts
)
7853 var
->var_part
[pos
] = var
->var_part
[pos
+ 1];
7858 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
7864 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
7865 variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value DV
7866 and offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
7869 delete_variable_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, decl_or_value dv
,
7870 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
7872 void **slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
7876 delete_slot_part (set
, loc
, slot
, offset
);
7880 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
7881 vt_expand_loc_callback. */
7882 struct expand_loc_callback_data
7884 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
7887 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs under expansion, and their
7889 vec
<rtx
, va_stack
> expanding
;
7891 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs whose expansion hit recursion
7892 cycles. They will have VALUE_RECURSED_INTO marked when added to
7893 this list. This flag will be cleared if any of its dependencies
7894 resolves to a valid location. So, if the flag remains set at the
7895 end of the search, we know no valid location for this one can
7897 vec
<rtx
, va_stack
> pending
;
7899 /* The maximum depth among the sub-expressions under expansion.
7900 Zero indicates no expansion so far. */
7904 /* Allocate the one-part auxiliary data structure for VAR, with enough
7905 room for COUNT dependencies. */
7908 loc_exp_dep_alloc (variable var
, int count
)
7912 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
);
7914 /* We can be called with COUNT == 0 to allocate the data structure
7915 without any dependencies, e.g. for the backlinks only. However,
7916 if we are specifying a COUNT, then the dependency list must have
7917 been emptied before. It would be possible to adjust pointers or
7918 force it empty here, but this is better done at an earlier point
7919 in the algorithm, so we instead leave an assertion to catch
7921 gcc_checking_assert (!count
7922 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
) == NULL
7923 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->is_empty ());
7925 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) && VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->space (count
))
7928 allocsize
= offsetof (struct onepart_aux
, deps
)
7929 + vec
<loc_exp_dep
, va_heap
, vl_embed
>::embedded_size (count
);
7931 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7933 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = XRESIZEVAR (struct onepart_aux
,
7934 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
), allocsize
);
7935 /* If the reallocation moves the onepaux structure, the
7936 back-pointer to BACKLINKS in the first list member will still
7937 point to its old location. Adjust it. */
7938 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
))
7939 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
)->pprev
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var
);
7943 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = XNEWVAR (struct onepart_aux
, allocsize
);
7944 *VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var
) = NULL
;
7945 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
7946 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var
).complexity
= 0;
7947 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var
).entryvals
= 0;
7949 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->embedded_init (count
);
7952 /* Remove all entries from the vector of active dependencies of VAR,
7953 removing them from the back-links lists too. */
7956 loc_exp_dep_clear (variable var
)
7958 while (VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
) && !VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->is_empty ())
7960 loc_exp_dep
*led
= &VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->last ();
7962 led
->next
->pprev
= led
->pprev
;
7964 *led
->pprev
= led
->next
;
7965 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->pop ();
7969 /* Insert an active dependency from VAR on X to the vector of
7970 dependencies, and add the corresponding back-link to X's list of
7971 back-links in VARS. */
7974 loc_exp_insert_dep (variable var
, rtx x
, htab_t vars
)
7980 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
7982 /* ??? Build a vector of variables parallel to EXPANDING, to avoid
7983 an additional look up? */
7984 xvar
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
7988 xvar
= variable_from_dropped (dv
, NO_INSERT
);
7989 gcc_checking_assert (xvar
);
7992 /* No point in adding the same backlink more than once. This may
7993 arise if say the same value appears in two complex expressions in
7994 the same loc_list, or even more than once in a single
7996 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar
) && VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar
)->dv
== var
->dv
)
7999 if (var
->onepart
== NOT_ONEPART
)
8000 led
= (loc_exp_dep
*) pool_alloc (loc_exp_dep_pool
);
8004 memset (&empty
, 0, sizeof (empty
));
8005 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->quick_push (empty
);
8006 led
= &VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->last ();
8011 loc_exp_dep_alloc (xvar
, 0);
8012 led
->pprev
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (xvar
);
8013 led
->next
= *led
->pprev
;
8015 led
->next
->pprev
= &led
->next
;
8019 /* Create active dependencies of VAR on COUNT values starting at
8020 VALUE, and corresponding back-links to the entries in VARS. Return
8021 true if we found any pending-recursion results. */
8024 loc_exp_dep_set (variable var
, rtx result
, rtx
*value
, int count
, htab_t vars
)
8026 bool pending_recursion
= false;
8028 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
) == NULL
8029 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->is_empty ());
8031 /* Set up all dependencies from last_child (as set up at the end of
8032 the loop above) to the end. */
8033 loc_exp_dep_alloc (var
, count
);
8039 if (!pending_recursion
)
8040 pending_recursion
= !result
&& VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
);
8042 loc_exp_insert_dep (var
, x
, vars
);
8045 return pending_recursion
;
8048 /* Notify the back-links of IVAR that are pending recursion that we
8049 have found a non-NIL value for it, so they are cleared for another
8050 attempt to compute a current location. */
8053 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (variable ivar
, htab_t vars
)
8055 loc_exp_dep
*led
, *next
;
8057 for (led
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar
); led
; led
= next
)
8059 decl_or_value dv
= led
->dv
;
8064 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
8066 rtx value
= dv_as_value (dv
);
8068 /* If we have already resolved it, leave it alone. */
8069 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value
))
8072 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO, true from the test above,
8073 implies NO_LOC_P. */
8074 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (value
));
8076 /* We won't notify variables that are being expanded,
8077 because their dependency list is cleared before
8079 NO_LOC_P (value
) = false;
8080 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value
) = false;
8082 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv
));
8086 gcc_checking_assert (dv_onepart_p (dv
) != NOT_ONEPART
);
8087 if (!dv_changed_p (dv
))
8091 var
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
8094 var
= variable_from_dropped (dv
, NO_INSERT
);
8097 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var
, vars
);
8100 next
->pprev
= led
->pprev
;
8108 static rtx
vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x
, bitmap regs
,
8109 int max_depth
, void *data
);
8111 /* Return the combined depth, when one sub-expression evaluated to
8112 BEST_DEPTH and the previous known depth was SAVED_DEPTH. */
8114 static inline expand_depth
8115 update_depth (expand_depth saved_depth
, expand_depth best_depth
)
8117 /* If we didn't find anything, stick with what we had. */
8118 if (!best_depth
.complexity
)
8121 /* If we found hadn't found anything, use the depth of the current
8122 expression. Do NOT add one extra level, we want to compute the
8123 maximum depth among sub-expressions. We'll increment it later,
8125 if (!saved_depth
.complexity
)
8128 /* Combine the entryval count so that regardless of which one we
8129 return, the entryval count is accurate. */
8130 best_depth
.entryvals
= saved_depth
.entryvals
8131 = best_depth
.entryvals
+ saved_depth
.entryvals
;
8133 if (saved_depth
.complexity
< best_depth
.complexity
)
8139 /* Expand VAR to a location RTX, updating its cur_loc. Use REGS and
8140 DATA for cselib expand callback. If PENDRECP is given, indicate in
8141 it whether any sub-expression couldn't be fully evaluated because
8142 it is pending recursion resolution. */
8145 vt_expand_var_loc_chain (variable var
, bitmap regs
, void *data
, bool *pendrecp
)
8147 struct expand_loc_callback_data
*elcd
8148 = (struct expand_loc_callback_data
*) data
;
8149 location_chain loc
, next
;
8151 int first_child
, result_first_child
, last_child
;
8152 bool pending_recursion
;
8153 rtx loc_from
= NULL
;
8154 struct elt_loc_list
*cloc
= NULL
;
8155 expand_depth depth
= { 0, 0 }, saved_depth
= elcd
->depth
;
8156 int wanted_entryvals
, found_entryvals
= 0;
8158 /* Clear all backlinks pointing at this, so that we're not notified
8159 while we're active. */
8160 loc_exp_dep_clear (var
);
8163 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
8165 cselib_val
*val
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (var
->dv
));
8167 gcc_checking_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (val
));
8172 first_child
= result_first_child
= last_child
8173 = elcd
->expanding
.length ();
8175 wanted_entryvals
= found_entryvals
;
8177 /* Attempt to expand each available location in turn. */
8178 for (next
= loc
= var
->n_var_parts
? var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
: NULL
;
8179 loc
|| cloc
; loc
= next
)
8181 result_first_child
= last_child
;
8185 loc_from
= cloc
->loc
;
8188 if (unsuitable_loc (loc_from
))
8193 loc_from
= loc
->loc
;
8197 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc_from
));
8199 elcd
->depth
.complexity
= elcd
->depth
.entryvals
= 0;
8200 result
= cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc_from
, regs
, EXPR_DEPTH
,
8201 vt_expand_loc_callback
, data
);
8202 last_child
= elcd
->expanding
.length ();
8206 depth
= elcd
->depth
;
8208 gcc_checking_assert (depth
.complexity
8209 || result_first_child
== last_child
);
8211 if (last_child
- result_first_child
!= 1)
8213 if (!depth
.complexity
&& GET_CODE (result
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
8218 if (depth
.complexity
<= EXPR_USE_DEPTH
)
8220 if (depth
.entryvals
<= wanted_entryvals
)
8222 else if (!found_entryvals
|| depth
.entryvals
< found_entryvals
)
8223 found_entryvals
= depth
.entryvals
;
8229 /* Set it up in case we leave the loop. */
8230 depth
.complexity
= depth
.entryvals
= 0;
8232 result_first_child
= first_child
;
8235 if (!loc_from
&& wanted_entryvals
< found_entryvals
)
8237 /* We found entries with ENTRY_VALUEs and skipped them. Since
8238 we could not find any expansions without ENTRY_VALUEs, but we
8239 found at least one with them, go back and get an entry with
8240 the minimum number ENTRY_VALUE count that we found. We could
8241 avoid looping, but since each sub-loc is already resolved,
8242 the re-expansion should be trivial. ??? Should we record all
8243 attempted locs as dependencies, so that we retry the
8244 expansion should any of them change, in the hope it can give
8245 us a new entry without an ENTRY_VALUE? */
8246 elcd
->expanding
.truncate (first_child
);
8250 /* Register all encountered dependencies as active. */
8251 pending_recursion
= loc_exp_dep_set
8252 (var
, result
, elcd
->expanding
.address () + result_first_child
,
8253 last_child
- result_first_child
, elcd
->vars
);
8255 elcd
->expanding
.truncate (first_child
);
8257 /* Record where the expansion came from. */
8258 gcc_checking_assert (!result
|| !pending_recursion
);
8259 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = loc_from
;
8260 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var
) = depth
;
8262 gcc_checking_assert (!depth
.complexity
== !result
);
8264 elcd
->depth
= update_depth (saved_depth
, depth
);
8266 /* Indicate whether any of the dependencies are pending recursion
8269 *pendrecp
= pending_recursion
;
8271 if (!pendrecp
|| !pending_recursion
)
8272 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= result
;
8277 /* Callback for cselib_expand_value, that looks for expressions
8278 holding the value in the var-tracking hash tables. Return X for
8279 standard processing, anything else is to be used as-is. */
8282 vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x
, bitmap regs
,
8283 int max_depth ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
8286 struct expand_loc_callback_data
*elcd
8287 = (struct expand_loc_callback_data
*) data
;
8291 bool pending_recursion
= false;
8292 bool from_empty
= false;
8294 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
8297 subreg
= cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (SUBREG_REG (x
), regs
,
8299 vt_expand_loc_callback
, data
);
8304 result
= simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (x
), subreg
,
8305 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x
)),
8308 /* Invalid SUBREGs are ok in debug info. ??? We could try
8309 alternate expansions for the VALUE as well. */
8311 result
= gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x
), subreg
, SUBREG_BYTE (x
));
8317 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
8324 elcd
->expanding
.safe_push (x
);
8326 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO implies NO_LOC_P. */
8327 gcc_checking_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) || NO_LOC_P (x
));
8331 gcc_checking_assert (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) || !dv_changed_p (dv
));
8335 var
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (elcd
->vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
8340 var
= variable_from_dropped (dv
, INSERT
);
8343 gcc_checking_assert (var
);
8345 if (!dv_changed_p (dv
))
8347 gcc_checking_assert (!NO_LOC_P (x
));
8348 gcc_checking_assert (var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
);
8349 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
));
8350 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
)->depth
.complexity
);
8352 elcd
->depth
= update_depth (elcd
->depth
, VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
)->depth
);
8354 return var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
8357 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) = true;
8358 /* This is tentative, but it makes some tests simpler. */
8359 NO_LOC_P (x
) = true;
8361 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1 || from_empty
);
8363 result
= vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var
, regs
, data
, &pending_recursion
);
8365 if (pending_recursion
)
8367 gcc_checking_assert (!result
);
8368 elcd
->pending
.safe_push (x
);
8372 NO_LOC_P (x
) = !result
;
8373 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) = false;
8374 set_dv_changed (dv
, false);
8377 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var
, elcd
->vars
);
8383 /* While expanding variables, we may encounter recursion cycles
8384 because of mutual (possibly indirect) dependencies between two
8385 particular variables (or values), say A and B. If we're trying to
8386 expand A when we get to B, which in turn attempts to expand A, if
8387 we can't find any other expansion for B, we'll add B to this
8388 pending-recursion stack, and tentatively return NULL for its
8389 location. This tentative value will be used for any other
8390 occurrences of B, unless A gets some other location, in which case
8391 it will notify B that it is worth another try at computing a
8392 location for it, and it will use the location computed for A then.
8393 At the end of the expansion, the tentative NULL locations become
8394 final for all members of PENDING that didn't get a notification.
8395 This function performs this finalization of NULL locations. */
8398 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion (vec
<rtx
, va_stack
> pending
)
8400 while (!pending
.is_empty ())
8402 rtx x
= pending
.pop ();
8405 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
))
8408 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (x
));
8409 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) = false;
8410 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
8411 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv
));
8412 set_dv_changed (dv
, false);
8416 /* Initialize expand_loc_callback_data D with variable hash table V.
8417 It must be a macro because of alloca (vec stack). */
8418 #define INIT_ELCD(d, v) \
8422 vec_stack_alloc (rtx, (d).expanding, 4); \
8423 vec_stack_alloc (rtx, (d).pending, 4); \
8424 (d).depth.complexity = (d).depth.entryvals = 0; \
8427 /* Finalize expand_loc_callback_data D, resolved to location L. */
8428 #define FINI_ELCD(d, l) \
8431 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion ((d).pending); \
8432 (d).pending.release (); \
8433 (d).expanding.release (); \
8435 if ((l) && MEM_P (l)) \
8436 (l) = targetm.delegitimize_address (l); \
8440 /* Expand VALUEs and DEBUG_EXPRs in LOC to a location, using the
8441 equivalences in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8444 vt_expand_loc (rtx loc
, htab_t vars
)
8446 struct expand_loc_callback_data data
;
8449 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
8452 INIT_ELCD (data
, vars
);
8454 result
= cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc
, scratch_regs
, EXPR_DEPTH
,
8455 vt_expand_loc_callback
, &data
);
8457 FINI_ELCD (data
, result
);
8462 /* Expand the one-part VARiable to a location, using the equivalences
8463 in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8466 vt_expand_1pvar (variable var
, htab_t vars
)
8468 struct expand_loc_callback_data data
;
8471 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
&& var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
8473 if (!dv_changed_p (var
->dv
))
8474 return var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
8476 INIT_ELCD (data
, vars
);
8478 loc
= vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var
, scratch_regs
, &data
, NULL
);
8480 gcc_checking_assert (data
.expanding
.is_empty ());
8482 FINI_ELCD (data
, loc
);
8487 /* Emit the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for variable *VARP. DATA contains
8488 additional parameters: WHERE specifies whether the note shall be emitted
8489 before or after instruction INSN. */
8492 emit_note_insn_var_location (void **varp
, void *data
)
8494 variable var
= (variable
) *varp
;
8495 rtx insn
= ((emit_note_data
*)data
)->insn
;
8496 enum emit_note_where where
= ((emit_note_data
*)data
)->where
;
8497 htab_t vars
= ((emit_note_data
*)data
)->vars
;
8499 int i
, j
, n_var_parts
;
8501 enum var_init_status initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
;
8502 HOST_WIDE_INT last_limit
;
8503 tree type_size_unit
;
8504 HOST_WIDE_INT offsets
[MAX_VAR_PARTS
];
8505 rtx loc
[MAX_VAR_PARTS
];
8509 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
== NOT_ONEPART
8510 || var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VDECL
);
8512 decl
= dv_as_decl (var
->dv
);
8518 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
8519 if (var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
== NULL
&& var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
)
8520 var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
->loc
;
8521 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
8523 enum machine_mode mode
, wider_mode
;
8525 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
8527 if (i
== 0 && var
->onepart
)
8529 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
8531 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
8532 loc2
= vt_expand_1pvar (var
, vars
);
8536 if (last_limit
< VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
))
8541 else if (last_limit
> VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
))
8543 offset
= VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
);
8544 loc2
= var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
;
8545 if (loc2
&& GET_CODE (loc2
) == MEM
8546 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc2
, 0)) == VALUE
)
8548 rtx depval
= XEXP (loc2
, 0);
8550 loc2
= vt_expand_loc (loc2
, vars
);
8553 loc_exp_insert_dep (var
, depval
, vars
);
8560 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc2
) != VALUE
);
8561 for (lc
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; lc
; lc
= lc
->next
)
8562 if (var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
== lc
->loc
)
8564 initialized
= lc
->init
;
8570 offsets
[n_var_parts
] = offset
;
8576 loc
[n_var_parts
] = loc2
;
8577 mode
= GET_MODE (var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
);
8578 if (mode
== VOIDmode
&& var
->onepart
)
8579 mode
= DECL_MODE (decl
);
8580 last_limit
= offsets
[n_var_parts
] + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
);
8582 /* Attempt to merge adjacent registers or memory. */
8583 wider_mode
= GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode
);
8584 for (j
= i
+ 1; j
< var
->n_var_parts
; j
++)
8585 if (last_limit
<= VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, j
))
8587 if (j
< var
->n_var_parts
8588 && wider_mode
!= VOIDmode
8589 && var
->var_part
[j
].cur_loc
8590 && mode
== GET_MODE (var
->var_part
[j
].cur_loc
)
8591 && (REG_P (loc
[n_var_parts
]) || MEM_P (loc
[n_var_parts
]))
8592 && last_limit
== (var
->onepart
? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, j
))
8593 && (loc2
= vt_expand_loc (var
->var_part
[j
].cur_loc
, vars
))
8594 && GET_CODE (loc
[n_var_parts
]) == GET_CODE (loc2
))
8598 if (REG_P (loc
[n_var_parts
])
8599 && hard_regno_nregs
[REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
])][mode
] * 2
8600 == hard_regno_nregs
[REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
])][wider_mode
]
8601 && end_hard_regno (mode
, REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
]))
8604 if (! WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
&& ! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
8605 new_loc
= simplify_subreg (wider_mode
, loc
[n_var_parts
],
8607 else if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
&& BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
8608 new_loc
= simplify_subreg (wider_mode
, loc2
, mode
, 0);
8611 if (!REG_P (new_loc
)
8612 || REGNO (new_loc
) != REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
]))
8615 REG_ATTRS (new_loc
) = REG_ATTRS (loc
[n_var_parts
]);
8618 else if (MEM_P (loc
[n_var_parts
])
8619 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc2
, 0)) == PLUS
8620 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 0))
8621 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 1)))
8623 if ((REG_P (XEXP (loc
[n_var_parts
], 0))
8624 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (loc
[n_var_parts
], 0),
8625 XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 0))
8626 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 1))
8627 == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
))
8628 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (loc
[n_var_parts
], 0)) == PLUS
8629 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc
[n_var_parts
], 0), 1))
8630 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (loc
[n_var_parts
], 0), 0),
8631 XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 0))
8632 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (loc
[n_var_parts
], 0), 1))
8633 + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
)
8634 == INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 1))))
8635 new_loc
= adjust_address_nv (loc
[n_var_parts
],
8641 loc
[n_var_parts
] = new_loc
;
8643 last_limit
= offsets
[n_var_parts
] + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
);
8649 type_size_unit
= TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (decl
));
8650 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
) last_limit
< TREE_INT_CST_LOW (type_size_unit
))
8653 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
8654 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
8658 note_vl
= gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode
, decl
, NULL_RTX
,
8660 else if (n_var_parts
== 1)
8664 if (offsets
[0] || GET_CODE (loc
[0]) == PARALLEL
)
8665 expr_list
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, loc
[0], GEN_INT (offsets
[0]));
8669 note_vl
= gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode
, decl
, expr_list
,
8672 else if (n_var_parts
)
8676 for (i
= 0; i
< n_var_parts
; i
++)
8678 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, loc
[i
], GEN_INT (offsets
[i
]));
8680 parallel
= gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
,
8681 gen_rtvec_v (n_var_parts
, loc
));
8682 note_vl
= gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode
, decl
,
8683 parallel
, (int) initialized
);
8686 if (where
!= EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
)
8688 note
= emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
, insn
);
8689 if (where
== EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
)
8690 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (note
) = true;
8694 /* Make sure that the call related notes come first. */
8695 while (NEXT_INSN (insn
)
8697 && ((NOTE_KIND (insn
) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
8698 && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn
))
8699 || NOTE_KIND (insn
) == NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION
))
8700 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
8702 && ((NOTE_KIND (insn
) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
8703 && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn
))
8704 || NOTE_KIND (insn
) == NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION
))
8705 note
= emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
, insn
);
8707 note
= emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
, insn
);
8709 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (note
) = note_vl
;
8711 set_dv_changed (var
->dv
, false);
8712 gcc_assert (var
->in_changed_variables
);
8713 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
8714 htab_clear_slot (changed_variables
, varp
);
8716 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8720 /* While traversing changed_variables, push onto DATA (a stack of RTX
8721 values) entries that aren't user variables. */
8724 values_to_stack (void **slot
, void *data
)
8726 vec
<rtx
, va_stack
> *changed_values_stack
= (vec
<rtx
, va_stack
> *) data
;
8727 variable var
= (variable
) *slot
;
8729 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
8730 changed_values_stack
->safe_push (dv_as_value (var
->dv
));
8731 else if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
8732 changed_values_stack
->safe_push (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (var
->dv
)));
8737 /* Remove from changed_variables the entry whose DV corresponds to
8738 value or debug_expr VAL. */
8740 remove_value_from_changed_variables (rtx val
)
8742 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_rtx (val
);
8746 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables
,
8747 dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), NO_INSERT
);
8748 var
= (variable
) *slot
;
8749 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
8750 htab_clear_slot (changed_variables
, slot
);
8753 /* If VAL (a value or debug_expr) has backlinks to variables actively
8754 dependent on it in HTAB or in CHANGED_VARIABLES, mark them as
8755 changed, adding to CHANGED_VALUES_STACK any dependencies that may
8756 have dependencies of their own to notify. */
8759 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (rtx val
, htab_t htab
,
8760 vec
<rtx
, va_stack
> *changed_values_stack
)
8765 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_rtx (val
);
8767 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (changed_variables
,
8768 dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), NO_INSERT
);
8770 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab
,
8771 dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), NO_INSERT
);
8773 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (dropped_values
,
8774 dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), NO_INSERT
);
8775 var
= (variable
) *slot
;
8777 while ((led
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
)))
8779 decl_or_value ldv
= led
->dv
;
8782 /* Deactivate and remove the backlink, as it was “used up”. It
8783 makes no sense to attempt to notify the same entity again:
8784 either it will be recomputed and re-register an active
8785 dependency, or it will still have the changed mark. */
8787 led
->next
->pprev
= led
->pprev
;
8789 *led
->pprev
= led
->next
;
8793 if (dv_changed_p (ldv
))
8796 switch (dv_onepart_p (ldv
))
8800 set_dv_changed (ldv
, true);
8801 changed_values_stack
->safe_push (dv_as_rtx (ldv
));
8805 ivar
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (htab
, ldv
, dv_htab_hash (ldv
));
8806 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar
));
8807 variable_was_changed (ivar
, NULL
);
8811 pool_free (loc_exp_dep_pool
, led
);
8812 ivar
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (htab
, ldv
, dv_htab_hash (ldv
));
8815 int i
= ivar
->n_var_parts
;
8818 rtx loc
= ivar
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
;
8820 if (loc
&& GET_CODE (loc
) == MEM
8821 && XEXP (loc
, 0) == val
)
8823 variable_was_changed (ivar
, NULL
);
8836 /* Take out of changed_variables any entries that don't refer to use
8837 variables. Back-propagate change notifications from values and
8838 debug_exprs to their active dependencies in HTAB or in
8839 CHANGED_VARIABLES. */
8842 process_changed_values (htab_t htab
)
8846 vec
<rtx
, va_stack
> changed_values_stack
;
8848 vec_stack_alloc (rtx
, changed_values_stack
, 20);
8850 /* Move values from changed_variables to changed_values_stack. */
8851 htab_traverse (changed_variables
, values_to_stack
, &changed_values_stack
);
8853 /* Back-propagate change notifications in values while popping
8854 them from the stack. */
8855 for (n
= i
= changed_values_stack
.length ();
8856 i
> 0; i
= changed_values_stack
.length ())
8858 val
= changed_values_stack
.pop ();
8859 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (val
, htab
, &changed_values_stack
);
8861 /* This condition will hold when visiting each of the entries
8862 originally in changed_variables. We can't remove them
8863 earlier because this could drop the backlinks before we got a
8864 chance to use them. */
8867 remove_value_from_changed_variables (val
);
8872 changed_values_stack
.release ();
8875 /* Emit NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION note for each variable from a chain
8876 CHANGED_VARIABLES and delete this chain. WHERE specifies whether
8877 the notes shall be emitted before of after instruction INSN. */
8880 emit_notes_for_changes (rtx insn
, enum emit_note_where where
,
8883 emit_note_data data
;
8884 htab_t htab
= shared_hash_htab (vars
);
8886 if (!htab_elements (changed_variables
))
8889 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
8890 process_changed_values (htab
);
8896 htab_traverse (changed_variables
, emit_note_insn_var_location
, &data
);
8899 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it differs from the
8900 same variable in hash table DATA or is not there at all. */
8903 emit_notes_for_differences_1 (void **slot
, void *data
)
8905 htab_t new_vars
= (htab_t
) data
;
8906 variable old_var
, new_var
;
8908 old_var
= (variable
) *slot
;
8909 new_var
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (new_vars
, old_var
->dv
,
8910 dv_htab_hash (old_var
->dv
));
8914 /* Variable has disappeared. */
8915 variable empty_var
= NULL
;
8917 if (old_var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
8918 || old_var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
8920 empty_var
= variable_from_dropped (old_var
->dv
, NO_INSERT
);
8923 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var
->in_changed_variables
);
8924 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
))
8926 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
);
8927 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = NULL
;
8930 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
));
8936 empty_var
= (variable
) pool_alloc (onepart_pool (old_var
->onepart
));
8937 empty_var
->dv
= old_var
->dv
;
8938 empty_var
->refcount
= 0;
8939 empty_var
->n_var_parts
= 0;
8940 empty_var
->onepart
= old_var
->onepart
;
8941 empty_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
8944 if (empty_var
->onepart
)
8946 /* Propagate the auxiliary data to (ultimately)
8947 changed_variables. */
8948 empty_var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
8949 empty_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
8950 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
);
8951 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = NULL
;
8953 variable_was_changed (empty_var
, NULL
);
8954 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8957 /* Update cur_loc and one-part auxiliary data, before new_var goes
8958 through variable_was_changed. */
8959 if (old_var
!= new_var
&& new_var
->onepart
)
8961 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var
) == NULL
);
8962 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
);
8963 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = NULL
;
8964 new_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= old_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
8966 if (variable_different_p (old_var
, new_var
))
8967 variable_was_changed (new_var
, NULL
);
8969 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8973 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it is not in hash
8977 emit_notes_for_differences_2 (void **slot
, void *data
)
8979 htab_t old_vars
= (htab_t
) data
;
8980 variable old_var
, new_var
;
8982 new_var
= (variable
) *slot
;
8983 old_var
= (variable
) htab_find_with_hash (old_vars
, new_var
->dv
,
8984 dv_htab_hash (new_var
->dv
));
8988 for (i
= 0; i
< new_var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
8989 new_var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
8990 variable_was_changed (new_var
, NULL
);
8993 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8997 /* Emit notes before INSN for differences between dataflow sets OLD_SET and
9001 emit_notes_for_differences (rtx insn
, dataflow_set
*old_set
,
9002 dataflow_set
*new_set
)
9004 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
),
9005 emit_notes_for_differences_1
,
9006 shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
));
9007 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
),
9008 emit_notes_for_differences_2
,
9009 shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
));
9010 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
, new_set
->vars
);
9013 /* Return the next insn after INSN that is not a NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION. */
9016 next_non_note_insn_var_location (rtx insn
)
9020 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
9023 || NOTE_KIND (insn
) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
)
9030 /* Emit the notes for changes of location parts in the basic block BB. */
9033 emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block bb
, dataflow_set
*set
)
9036 micro_operation
*mo
;
9038 dataflow_set_clear (set
);
9039 dataflow_set_copy (set
, &VTI (bb
)->in
);
9041 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (VTI (bb
)->mos
, i
, mo
)
9043 rtx insn
= mo
->insn
;
9044 rtx next_insn
= next_non_note_insn_var_location (insn
);
9049 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (set
);
9050 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9052 rtx arguments
= mo
->u
.loc
, *p
= &arguments
, note
;
9055 XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1)
9056 = vt_expand_loc (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1),
9057 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
));
9058 /* If expansion is successful, keep it in the list. */
9059 if (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1))
9061 /* Otherwise, if the following item is data_value for it,
9063 else if (XEXP (*p
, 1)
9064 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 0))
9065 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 0), 0))
9066 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 0), 0),
9068 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 0))
9069 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 0),
9071 *p
= XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 1);
9072 /* Just drop this item. */
9076 note
= emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION
, insn
);
9077 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (note
) = arguments
;
9083 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9086 var_reg_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
9088 var_mem_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
9090 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9096 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9100 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == CONCAT
)
9102 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
9103 vloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
9111 var
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc
);
9113 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL_RTX
,
9114 dv_from_decl (var
), 0, NULL_RTX
);
9117 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9118 val_resolve (set
, val
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
), insn
);
9119 set_variable_part (set
, val
, dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
9120 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
9123 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
)))
9124 set_variable_part (set
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
),
9125 dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
9126 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
9129 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9135 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9136 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
9138 vloc
= uloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
9139 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
9141 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
9143 uloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
9144 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
9147 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9148 val_resolve (set
, val
, vloc
, insn
);
9150 val_store (set
, val
, uloc
, insn
, false);
9152 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
9154 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == REG
)
9155 var_reg_set (set
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
9157 else if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == MEM
)
9158 var_mem_set (set
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
9162 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9168 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9169 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
9173 uloc
= XEXP (vloc
, 1);
9174 val
= XEXP (vloc
, 0);
9177 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
9179 dstv
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
9180 srcv
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
9188 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
9190 dstv
= vloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
9191 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
9194 if (GET_CODE (vloc
) == SET
)
9196 srcv
= SET_SRC (vloc
);
9198 gcc_assert (val
!= srcv
);
9199 gcc_assert (vloc
== uloc
|| VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
));
9201 dstv
= vloc
= SET_DEST (vloc
);
9203 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9204 val_resolve (set
, val
, srcv
, insn
);
9206 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9208 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
9209 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc
)) == REG
);
9210 val_resolve (set
, val
, SET_SRC (uloc
), insn
);
9213 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
9215 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc
))
9218 var_reg_delete (set
, uloc
, true);
9219 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
9221 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
9222 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (uloc
));
9223 var_mem_delete (set
, dstv
, true);
9228 bool copied_p
= VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc
);
9229 rtx src
= NULL
, dst
= uloc
;
9230 enum var_init_status status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
9232 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
9234 src
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
9235 dst
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
9240 status
= find_src_status (set
, src
);
9242 src
= find_src_set_src (set
, src
);
9246 var_reg_delete_and_set (set
, dst
, !copied_p
,
9248 else if (MEM_P (dst
))
9250 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
9251 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (dst
));
9252 var_mem_delete_and_set (set
, dstv
, !copied_p
,
9257 else if (REG_P (uloc
))
9258 var_regno_delete (set
, REGNO (uloc
));
9259 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
9261 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (vloc
) == MEM
);
9262 gcc_checking_assert (vloc
== dstv
);
9264 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, vloc
);
9267 val_store (set
, val
, dstv
, insn
, true);
9269 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9276 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9279 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
9281 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
9282 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
9286 var_reg_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
9289 var_mem_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
9292 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9299 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9300 enum var_init_status src_status
;
9303 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
9305 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
9306 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
9309 src_status
= find_src_status (set
, set_src
);
9310 set_src
= find_src_set_src (set
, set_src
);
9313 var_reg_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
9315 var_mem_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
9317 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9324 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9327 var_reg_delete (set
, loc
, false);
9329 var_mem_delete (set
, loc
, false);
9331 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9337 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9340 var_reg_delete (set
, loc
, true);
9342 var_mem_delete (set
, loc
, true);
9344 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9350 set
->stack_adjust
+= mo
->u
.adjust
;
9356 /* Emit notes for the whole function. */
9359 vt_emit_notes (void)
9364 gcc_assert (!htab_elements (changed_variables
));
9366 /* Free memory occupied by the out hash tables, as they aren't used
9369 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
9371 /* Enable emitting notes by functions (mainly by set_variable_part and
9372 delete_variable_part). */
9375 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9377 dropped_values
= htab_create (cselib_get_next_uid () * 2,
9378 variable_htab_hash
, variable_htab_eq
,
9379 variable_htab_free
);
9380 loc_exp_dep_pool
= create_alloc_pool ("loc_exp_dep pool",
9381 sizeof (loc_exp_dep
), 64);
9384 dataflow_set_init (&cur
);
9388 /* Emit the notes for changes of variable locations between two
9389 subsequent basic blocks. */
9390 emit_notes_for_differences (BB_HEAD (bb
), &cur
, &VTI (bb
)->in
);
9392 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9393 local_get_addr_cache
= pointer_map_create ();
9395 /* Emit the notes for the changes in the basic block itself. */
9396 emit_notes_in_bb (bb
, &cur
);
9398 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9399 pointer_map_destroy (local_get_addr_cache
);
9400 local_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
9402 /* Free memory occupied by the in hash table, we won't need it
9404 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
9406 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9407 htab_traverse (shared_hash_htab (cur
.vars
),
9408 emit_notes_for_differences_1
,
9409 shared_hash_htab (empty_shared_hash
));
9411 dataflow_set_destroy (&cur
);
9413 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9414 htab_delete (dropped_values
);
9419 /* If there is a declaration and offset associated with register/memory RTL
9420 assign declaration to *DECLP and offset to *OFFSETP, and return true. */
9423 vt_get_decl_and_offset (rtx rtl
, tree
*declp
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*offsetp
)
9427 if (REG_ATTRS (rtl
))
9429 *declp
= REG_EXPR (rtl
);
9430 *offsetp
= REG_OFFSET (rtl
);
9434 else if (MEM_P (rtl
))
9436 if (MEM_ATTRS (rtl
))
9438 *declp
= MEM_EXPR (rtl
);
9439 *offsetp
= INT_MEM_OFFSET (rtl
);
9446 /* Record the value for the ENTRY_VALUE of RTL as a global equivalence
9450 record_entry_value (cselib_val
*val
, rtx rtl
)
9452 rtx ev
= gen_rtx_ENTRY_VALUE (GET_MODE (rtl
));
9454 ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (ev
) = rtl
;
9456 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val
, ev
, get_insns ());
9459 /* Insert function parameter PARM in IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
9462 vt_add_function_parameter (tree parm
)
9464 rtx decl_rtl
= DECL_RTL_IF_SET (parm
);
9465 rtx incoming
= DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm
);
9467 enum machine_mode mode
;
9468 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
9472 if (TREE_CODE (parm
) != PARM_DECL
)
9475 if (!decl_rtl
|| !incoming
)
9478 if (GET_MODE (decl_rtl
) == BLKmode
|| GET_MODE (incoming
) == BLKmode
)
9481 /* If there is a DRAP register or a pseudo in internal_arg_pointer,
9482 rewrite the incoming location of parameters passed on the stack
9483 into MEMs based on the argument pointer, so that incoming doesn't
9484 depend on a pseudo. */
9485 if (MEM_P (incoming
)
9486 && (XEXP (incoming
, 0) == crtl
->args
.internal_arg_pointer
9487 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (incoming
, 0)) == PLUS
9488 && XEXP (XEXP (incoming
, 0), 0)
9489 == crtl
->args
.internal_arg_pointer
9490 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (incoming
, 0), 1)))))
9492 HOST_WIDE_INT off
= -FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9493 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (incoming
, 0)) == PLUS
)
9494 off
+= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (incoming
, 0), 1));
9496 = replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming
,
9497 plus_constant (Pmode
,
9498 arg_pointer_rtx
, off
));
9501 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
9502 /* DECL_INCOMING_RTL uses the INCOMING_REGNO of parameter registers.
9503 If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
9504 actual entry value is the corresponding OUTGOING_REGNO instead. */
9505 if (HAVE_window_save
&& !crtl
->uses_only_leaf_regs
)
9507 if (REG_P (incoming
)
9508 && HARD_REGISTER_P (incoming
)
9509 && OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming
)) != REGNO (incoming
))
9512 p
.incoming
= incoming
;
9514 = gen_rtx_REG_offset (incoming
, GET_MODE (incoming
),
9515 OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming
)), 0);
9516 p
.outgoing
= incoming
;
9517 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs
, p
);
9519 else if (MEM_P (incoming
)
9520 && REG_P (XEXP (incoming
, 0))
9521 && HARD_REGISTER_P (XEXP (incoming
, 0)))
9523 rtx reg
= XEXP (incoming
, 0);
9524 if (OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg
)) != REGNO (reg
))
9528 reg
= gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (reg
), OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg
)));
9530 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs
, p
);
9531 incoming
= replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming
, reg
);
9537 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (incoming
, &decl
, &offset
))
9539 if (REG_P (incoming
) || MEM_P (incoming
))
9541 /* This means argument is passed by invisible reference. */
9544 incoming
= gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (decl_rtl
), incoming
);
9548 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (decl_rtl
, &decl
, &offset
))
9550 offset
+= byte_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (incoming
),
9551 GET_MODE (decl_rtl
));
9560 /* If that DECL_RTL wasn't a pseudo that got spilled to
9561 memory, bail out. Otherwise, the spill slot sharing code
9562 will force the memory to reference spill_slot_decl (%sfp),
9563 so we don't match above. That's ok, the pseudo must have
9564 referenced the entire parameter, so just reset OFFSET. */
9565 if (decl
!= get_spill_slot_decl (false))
9570 if (!track_loc_p (incoming
, parm
, offset
, false, &mode
, &offset
))
9573 out
= &VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR
)->out
;
9575 dv
= dv_from_decl (parm
);
9577 if (target_for_debug_bind (parm
)
9578 /* We can't deal with these right now, because this kind of
9579 variable is single-part. ??? We could handle parallels
9580 that describe multiple locations for the same single
9581 value, but ATM we don't. */
9582 && GET_CODE (incoming
) != PARALLEL
)
9587 /* ??? We shouldn't ever hit this, but it may happen because
9588 arguments passed by invisible reference aren't dealt with
9589 above: incoming-rtl will have Pmode rather than the
9590 expected mode for the type. */
9594 lowpart
= var_lowpart (mode
, incoming
);
9598 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (lowpart
, mode
, true,
9599 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9601 /* ??? Float-typed values in memory are not handled by
9605 preserve_value (val
);
9606 set_variable_part (out
, val
->val_rtx
, dv
, offset
,
9607 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9608 dv
= dv_from_value (val
->val_rtx
);
9611 if (MEM_P (incoming
))
9613 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (XEXP (incoming
, 0), mode
, true,
9614 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9617 preserve_value (val
);
9618 incoming
= replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming
, val
->val_rtx
);
9623 if (REG_P (incoming
))
9625 incoming
= var_lowpart (mode
, incoming
);
9626 gcc_assert (REGNO (incoming
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
);
9627 attrs_list_insert (&out
->regs
[REGNO (incoming
)], dv
, offset
,
9629 set_variable_part (out
, incoming
, dv
, offset
,
9630 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9631 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
9633 record_entry_value (CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (dv
)), incoming
);
9634 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm
)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
9635 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm
))))
9637 enum machine_mode indmode
9638 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm
)));
9639 rtx mem
= gen_rtx_MEM (indmode
, incoming
);
9640 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (mem
, indmode
, true,
9645 preserve_value (val
);
9646 record_entry_value (val
, mem
);
9647 set_variable_part (out
, mem
, dv_from_value (val
->val_rtx
), 0,
9648 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9653 else if (MEM_P (incoming
))
9655 incoming
= var_lowpart (mode
, incoming
);
9656 set_variable_part (out
, incoming
, dv
, offset
,
9657 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9661 /* Insert function parameters to IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
9664 vt_add_function_parameters (void)
9668 for (parm
= DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl
);
9669 parm
; parm
= DECL_CHAIN (parm
))
9670 vt_add_function_parameter (parm
);
9672 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl
)))
9674 tree vexpr
= DECL_VALUE_EXPR (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl
));
9676 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr
) == INDIRECT_REF
)
9677 vexpr
= TREE_OPERAND (vexpr
, 0);
9679 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr
) == PARM_DECL
9680 && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (vexpr
)
9681 && !DECL_IGNORED_P (vexpr
)
9682 && DECL_NAMELESS (vexpr
))
9683 vt_add_function_parameter (vexpr
);
9687 /* Initialize cfa_base_rtx, create a preserved VALUE for it and
9688 ensure it isn't flushed during cselib_reset_table.
9689 Can be called only if frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
9690 has been eliminated. */
9693 vt_init_cfa_base (void)
9697 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9698 cfa_base_rtx
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
9699 cfa_base_offset
= -FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9701 cfa_base_rtx
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
9702 cfa_base_offset
= -ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9704 if (cfa_base_rtx
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
9705 || !fixed_regs
[REGNO (cfa_base_rtx
)])
9707 cfa_base_rtx
= NULL_RTX
;
9710 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9713 /* Tell alias analysis that cfa_base_rtx should share
9714 find_base_term value with stack pointer or hard frame pointer. */
9715 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
9716 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx
, stack_pointer_rtx
);
9717 else if (!crtl
->stack_realign_tried
)
9718 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx
, hard_frame_pointer_rtx
);
9720 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (cfa_base_rtx
, GET_MODE (cfa_base_rtx
), 1,
9721 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9722 preserve_value (val
);
9723 cselib_preserve_cfa_base_value (val
, REGNO (cfa_base_rtx
));
9726 /* Allocate and initialize the data structures for variable tracking
9727 and parse the RTL to get the micro operations. */
9730 vt_initialize (void)
9733 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_cfa_offset
= -1;
9735 alloc_aux_for_blocks (sizeof (struct variable_tracking_info_def
));
9737 attrs_pool
= create_alloc_pool ("attrs_def pool",
9738 sizeof (struct attrs_def
), 1024);
9739 var_pool
= create_alloc_pool ("variable_def pool",
9740 sizeof (struct variable_def
)
9741 + (MAX_VAR_PARTS
- 1)
9742 * sizeof (((variable
)NULL
)->var_part
[0]), 64);
9743 loc_chain_pool
= create_alloc_pool ("location_chain_def pool",
9744 sizeof (struct location_chain_def
),
9746 shared_hash_pool
= create_alloc_pool ("shared_hash_def pool",
9747 sizeof (struct shared_hash_def
), 256);
9748 empty_shared_hash
= (shared_hash
) pool_alloc (shared_hash_pool
);
9749 empty_shared_hash
->refcount
= 1;
9750 empty_shared_hash
->htab
9751 = htab_create (1, variable_htab_hash
, variable_htab_eq
,
9752 variable_htab_free
);
9753 changed_variables
= htab_create (10, variable_htab_hash
, variable_htab_eq
,
9754 variable_htab_free
);
9756 /* Init the IN and OUT sets. */
9759 VTI (bb
)->visited
= false;
9760 VTI (bb
)->flooded
= false;
9761 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
9762 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
9763 VTI (bb
)->permp
= NULL
;
9766 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9768 cselib_init (CSELIB_RECORD_MEMORY
| CSELIB_PRESERVE_CONSTANTS
);
9769 scratch_regs
= BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL
);
9770 valvar_pool
= create_alloc_pool ("small variable_def pool",
9771 sizeof (struct variable_def
), 256);
9772 preserved_values
.create (256);
9773 global_get_addr_cache
= pointer_map_create ();
9777 scratch_regs
= NULL
;
9779 global_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
9782 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9788 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9789 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
9790 ofst
= FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9792 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
9793 ofst
= ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9796 ofst
-= INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
;
9798 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (reg
, GET_MODE (reg
), 1,
9799 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9800 preserve_value (val
);
9801 cselib_preserve_cfa_base_value (val
, REGNO (reg
));
9802 expr
= plus_constant (GET_MODE (stack_pointer_rtx
),
9803 stack_pointer_rtx
, -ofst
);
9804 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val
, expr
, get_insns ());
9808 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (stack_pointer_rtx
,
9809 GET_MODE (stack_pointer_rtx
), 1,
9810 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9811 preserve_value (val
);
9812 expr
= plus_constant (GET_MODE (reg
), reg
, ofst
);
9813 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val
, expr
, get_insns ());
9817 /* In order to factor out the adjustments made to the stack pointer or to
9818 the hard frame pointer and thus be able to use DW_OP_fbreg operations
9819 instead of individual location lists, we're going to rewrite MEMs based
9820 on them into MEMs based on the CFA by de-eliminating stack_pointer_rtx
9821 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx to the virtual CFA pointer frame_pointer_rtx
9822 resp. arg_pointer_rtx. We can do this either when there is no frame
9823 pointer in the function and stack adjustments are consistent for all
9824 basic blocks or when there is a frame pointer and no stack realignment.
9825 But we first have to check that frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
9826 has been eliminated. */
9827 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
9831 if (!vt_stack_adjustments ())
9834 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9835 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
9837 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
9839 elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
9842 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
9843 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
9844 if (elim
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
9845 vt_init_cfa_base ();
9848 else if (!crtl
->stack_realign_tried
)
9852 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9853 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
9854 fp_cfa_offset
= FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9856 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
9857 fp_cfa_offset
= ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9859 elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
9862 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
9864 fp_cfa_offset
-= INTVAL (XEXP (elim
, 1));
9865 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
9867 if (elim
!= hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
9874 /* If the stack is realigned and a DRAP register is used, we're going to
9875 rewrite MEMs based on it representing incoming locations of parameters
9876 passed on the stack into MEMs based on the argument pointer. Although
9877 we aren't going to rewrite other MEMs, we still need to initialize the
9878 virtual CFA pointer in order to ensure that the argument pointer will
9879 be seen as a constant throughout the function.
9881 ??? This doesn't work if FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET is defined. */
9882 else if (stack_realign_drap
)
9886 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9887 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
9889 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
9891 elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
9894 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
9895 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
9896 if (elim
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
9897 vt_init_cfa_base ();
9901 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= -1;
9903 vt_add_function_parameters ();
9908 HOST_WIDE_INT pre
, post
= 0;
9909 basic_block first_bb
, last_bb
;
9911 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9913 cselib_record_sets_hook
= add_with_sets
;
9914 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
9915 fprintf (dump_file
, "first value: %i\n",
9916 cselib_get_next_uid ());
9923 if (bb
->next_bb
== EXIT_BLOCK_PTR
9924 || ! single_pred_p (bb
->next_bb
))
9926 e
= find_edge (bb
, bb
->next_bb
);
9927 if (! e
|| (e
->flags
& EDGE_FALLTHRU
) == 0)
9933 /* Add the micro-operations to the vector. */
9934 FOR_BB_BETWEEN (bb
, first_bb
, last_bb
->next_bb
, next_bb
)
9936 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
9937 VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
= VTI (bb
)->in
.stack_adjust
;
9938 for (insn
= BB_HEAD (bb
); insn
!= NEXT_INSN (BB_END (bb
));
9939 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
))
9943 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
9945 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn
, &pre
, &post
);
9949 mo
.type
= MO_ADJUST
;
9952 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
9953 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn
), bb
, insn
,
9954 MO_ADJUST
, dump_file
);
9955 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
9956 VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
+= pre
;
9960 cselib_hook_called
= false;
9961 adjust_insn (bb
, insn
);
9962 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
9965 prepare_call_arguments (bb
, insn
);
9966 cselib_process_insn (insn
);
9967 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
9969 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, insn
);
9970 dump_cselib_table (dump_file
);
9973 if (!cselib_hook_called
)
9974 add_with_sets (insn
, 0, 0);
9977 if (!frame_pointer_needed
&& post
)
9980 mo
.type
= MO_ADJUST
;
9983 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
9984 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn
), bb
, insn
,
9985 MO_ADJUST
, dump_file
);
9986 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
9987 VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
+= post
;
9990 if (fp_cfa_offset
!= -1
9991 && hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
== -1
9992 && fp_setter_insn (insn
))
9994 vt_init_cfa_base ();
9995 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= fp_cfa_offset
;
9996 /* Disassociate sp from fp now. */
9997 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
10000 cselib_invalidate_rtx (stack_pointer_rtx
);
10001 v
= cselib_lookup (stack_pointer_rtx
, Pmode
, 1,
10003 if (v
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (v
))
10005 cselib_set_value_sp_based (v
);
10006 preserve_value (v
);
10012 gcc_assert (offset
== VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
);
10017 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
10019 cselib_preserve_only_values ();
10020 cselib_reset_table (cselib_get_next_uid ());
10021 cselib_record_sets_hook
= NULL
;
10025 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= -1;
10026 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR
)->flooded
= true;
10027 cfa_base_rtx
= NULL_RTX
;
10031 /* This is *not* reset after each function. It gives each
10032 NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL in the entire compilation
10033 a unique label number. */
10035 static int debug_label_num
= 1;
10037 /* Get rid of all debug insns from the insn stream. */
10040 delete_debug_insns (void)
10045 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
10050 FOR_BB_INSNS_SAFE (bb
, insn
, next
)
10051 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn
))
10053 tree decl
= INSN_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (insn
);
10054 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == LABEL_DECL
10055 && DECL_NAME (decl
)
10056 && !DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl
))
10058 PUT_CODE (insn
, NOTE
);
10059 NOTE_KIND (insn
) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
;
10060 NOTE_DELETED_LABEL_NAME (insn
)
10061 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl
));
10062 SET_DECL_RTL (decl
, insn
);
10063 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn
) = debug_label_num
++;
10066 delete_insn (insn
);
10071 /* Run a fast, BB-local only version of var tracking, to take care of
10072 information that we don't do global analysis on, such that not all
10073 information is lost. If SKIPPED holds, we're skipping the global
10074 pass entirely, so we should try to use information it would have
10075 handled as well.. */
10078 vt_debug_insns_local (bool skipped ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
10080 /* ??? Just skip it all for now. */
10081 delete_debug_insns ();
10084 /* Free the data structures needed for variable tracking. */
10093 VTI (bb
)->mos
.release ();
10098 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
10099 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
10100 if (VTI (bb
)->permp
)
10102 dataflow_set_destroy (VTI (bb
)->permp
);
10103 XDELETE (VTI (bb
)->permp
);
10106 free_aux_for_blocks ();
10107 htab_delete (empty_shared_hash
->htab
);
10108 htab_delete (changed_variables
);
10109 free_alloc_pool (attrs_pool
);
10110 free_alloc_pool (var_pool
);
10111 free_alloc_pool (loc_chain_pool
);
10112 free_alloc_pool (shared_hash_pool
);
10114 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
10116 if (global_get_addr_cache
)
10117 pointer_map_destroy (global_get_addr_cache
);
10118 global_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
10119 if (loc_exp_dep_pool
)
10120 free_alloc_pool (loc_exp_dep_pool
);
10121 loc_exp_dep_pool
= NULL
;
10122 free_alloc_pool (valvar_pool
);
10123 preserved_values
.release ();
10125 BITMAP_FREE (scratch_regs
);
10126 scratch_regs
= NULL
;
10129 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
10130 vec_free (windowed_parm_regs
);
10134 XDELETEVEC (vui_vec
);
10139 /* The entry point to variable tracking pass. */
10141 static inline unsigned int
10142 variable_tracking_main_1 (void)
10146 if (flag_var_tracking_assignments
< 0)
10148 delete_debug_insns ();
10152 if (n_basic_blocks
> 500 && n_edges
/ n_basic_blocks
>= 20)
10154 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
10158 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
10159 if (!vt_initialize ())
10162 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
10166 success
= vt_find_locations ();
10168 if (!success
&& flag_var_tracking_assignments
> 0)
10172 delete_debug_insns ();
10174 /* This is later restored by our caller. */
10175 flag_var_tracking_assignments
= 0;
10177 success
= vt_initialize ();
10178 gcc_assert (success
);
10180 success
= vt_find_locations ();
10186 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
10190 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
10192 dump_dataflow_sets ();
10193 dump_reg_info (dump_file
);
10194 dump_flow_info (dump_file
, dump_flags
);
10197 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT
);
10199 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT
);
10202 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
10207 variable_tracking_main (void)
10210 int save
= flag_var_tracking_assignments
;
10212 ret
= variable_tracking_main_1 ();
10214 flag_var_tracking_assignments
= save
;
10220 gate_handle_var_tracking (void)
10222 return (flag_var_tracking
&& !targetm
.delay_vartrack
);
10227 struct rtl_opt_pass pass_variable_tracking
=
10231 "vartrack", /* name */
10232 OPTGROUP_NONE
, /* optinfo_flags */
10233 gate_handle_var_tracking
, /* gate */
10234 variable_tracking_main
, /* execute */
10237 0, /* static_pass_number */
10238 TV_VAR_TRACKING
, /* tv_id */
10239 0, /* properties_required */
10240 0, /* properties_provided */
10241 0, /* properties_destroyed */
10242 0, /* todo_flags_start */
10243 TODO_verify_rtl_sharing
/* todo_flags_finish */